blob: 69da6bee24ecfbb63729054f6838e82f2e6cc7f9 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau1c0a7222020-11-05 17:04:53 +01007 2020/11/05
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
407 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
408 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
409 "frontend" and "backend".
410
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100411The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
412referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200413delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200415
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004162.2. Quoting and escaping
417-------------------------
418
419HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
420many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
421with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
422single quotes.
423
424If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
425them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
426escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
427
428Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
429
430 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
431 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
432 \\ to use a backslash
433 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
434 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
435
436Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
437the interpretation of:
438
439 space as a parameter separator
440 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
441 # hash as a comment start
442
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200443Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
444-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
445backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
446
447Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200448quoting.
449
450Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
451nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
452
453Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
454equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
455
456 Example:
457 # those are equivalents:
458 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
459 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
460 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
462 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
463
464 # those are equivalents:
465 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
468 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
469
470
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004712.3. Environment variables
472--------------------------
473
474HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
475interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
476configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
477optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
478shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200479underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
480list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
481arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
482before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200483
484 Example:
485
486 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
487
488 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
489
490 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
491
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200492Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
493file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200494
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200495* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
496 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
497
498* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
499 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
500 directory.
501
502* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
503
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500504* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200505 processes, separated by semicolons.
506
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500507* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200508 CLI, separated by semicolons.
509
510See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200511
5122.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200513----------------
514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100515Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100516values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
517otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
518numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
519for every keyword. Supported units are :
520
521 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
522 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
523 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
524 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
525 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
526 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
527
528
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005292.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200530-------------
531
532 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
533 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
534 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
535 global
536 daemon
537 maxconn 256
538
539 defaults
540 mode http
541 timeout connect 5000ms
542 timeout client 50000ms
543 timeout server 50000ms
544
545 frontend http-in
546 bind *:80
547 default_backend servers
548
549 backend servers
550 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
551
552
553 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
554 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
555 global
556 daemon
557 maxconn 256
558
559 defaults
560 mode http
561 timeout connect 5000ms
562 timeout client 50000ms
563 timeout server 50000ms
564
565 listen http-in
566 bind *:80
567 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
568
569
570Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
571
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100572 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200573
574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005753. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576--------------------
577
578Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
579are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
580of them have command-line equivalents.
581
582The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
583
584 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200585 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - description
591 - deviceatlas-json-file
592 - deviceatlas-log-level
593 - deviceatlas-separator
594 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900595 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596 - gid
597 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100598 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200599 - h1-case-adjust
600 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100601 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100602 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100603 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200604 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100607 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100609 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200610 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200612 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200613 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200615 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100616 - presetenv
617 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618 - uid
619 - ulimit-n
620 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200621 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100622 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200623 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-options
628 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200630 - ssl-default-server-options
631 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100632 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200633 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100634 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100635 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100636 - 51degrees-data-file
637 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200638 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200639 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200640 - wurfl-data-file
641 - wurfl-information-list
642 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200643 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100644 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100647 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200648 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200650 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100651 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100652 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100653 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200654 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200655 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200656 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200657 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658 - noepoll
659 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000660 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100662 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300663 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000664 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100665 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200666 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200667 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200668 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000669 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000670 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200671 - tune.buffers.limit
672 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200673 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200674 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100675 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200676 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200677 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200678 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200679 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100680 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200681 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200682 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200683 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100684 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100685 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100686 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100687 - tune.lua.session-timeout
688 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200689 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100690 - tune.maxaccept
691 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200692 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200693 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200694 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200695 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
696 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100697 - tune.rcvbuf.client
698 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100699 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200700 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200701 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100702 - tune.sndbuf.client
703 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100704 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200705 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100706 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200707 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100708 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200709 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200710 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100711 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200712 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100713 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200714 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
715 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
716 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100717 - tune.zlib.memlevel
718 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100719
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200722 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723
724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007253.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200726------------------------------------
727
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200728ca-base <dir>
729 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100730 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
731 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
732 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200734chroot <jail dir>
735 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
736 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
737 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
738 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
739 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100740 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100741
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
743 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
744 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
745 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
746 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
747 set. These sets have the format
748
749 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
750
751 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100752 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100753 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
754 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100755 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
756 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100757 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100758 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100760 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100761 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
762 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
763 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
764 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100765
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100766 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
767 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
768 on the machine's word size.
769
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100770 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100771 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
772 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
773 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
774 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
775 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
776 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100777
778 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100779 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
780
781 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
782 # first 4 CPUs
783
784 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
785 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
786 # word size.
787
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100788 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100789 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100790 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
791 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
792 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
793
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100794 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
795 # and so on.
796 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
797 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
798 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
799
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100800 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100801 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
802 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
803 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
804
805 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
806 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
808
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100809 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
810 # and a thread range.
811 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
812 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
813 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
814
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200815crt-base <dir>
816 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100817 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
818 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200819
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820daemon
821 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
822 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100823 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
824 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200825
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826deviceatlas-json-file <path>
827 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200829
830deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100831 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200832 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
833
834deviceatlas-separator <char>
835 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
836 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
837
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100838deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200839 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
840 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
841 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100842
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900843external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100844 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
845 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100846 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
847 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
848 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
849 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
850 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900851
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200852gid <number>
853 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
854 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
855 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100856 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
857 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200858 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100859
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100860group <group name>
861 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
862 See also "gid" and "user".
863
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100864hard-stop-after <time>
865 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
866
867 Arguments :
868 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
869 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
870 SIGUSR1 signal.
871
872 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
873 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
874 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
875
876 Example:
877 global
878 hard-stop-after 30s
879
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200880h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
881 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
882 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
883 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
884 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500885 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200886 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
887 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
888 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
889 specified in a proxy.
890
891 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
892 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
893 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
894 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
895 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
896 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
897 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
898
899 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
900 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
901 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
902 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
903 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
904
905 Example:
906 global
907 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
908
909 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
910 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
911
912h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
913 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
914 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
915 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
916 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
917 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
918 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
919 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
920 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
921
922 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
923 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
924 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
925
926 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
927 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
928
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100929insecure-fork-wanted
930 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
931 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
932 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
933 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
934 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
935 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
936 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
937 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
938 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
939 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
940 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
941 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
942 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
943 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
944 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
945 disable it.
946
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100947insecure-setuid-wanted
948 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
949 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
950 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
951 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
952 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
953 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
954 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
955 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
956 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
957 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
958 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
959 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
960 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
961 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
962
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100963issuers-chain-path <dir>
964 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
965 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
966 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
967 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
968 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
969 "issuers-chain-path".
970 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
971 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
972 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
973 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
974 will share the chain in memory.
975
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200976localpeer <name>
977 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
978 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
979 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
980 the configuration parsing.
981
982 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
983 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
984
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200985log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
986 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100987 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100989 configured with "log global".
990
991 <address> can be one of:
992
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100993 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100994 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
995 port).
996
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100997 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
998 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
999 port).
1000
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001001 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001002 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1003 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001004 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001005
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001006 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1007 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1008 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1009 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1010 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1011 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1012 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1013 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1014 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1015 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1016 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1017 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1018 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1019 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001020 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1021 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001022
1023 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1024 "fd@2", see above.
1025
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001026 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1027 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1028 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1029 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1030 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1031
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001032 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1033 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001034
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001035 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1036 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1037 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1038 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1039 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1040 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1041 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1042 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1043 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1044 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001045 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1046 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001047
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001048 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1049 one of the following :
1050
1051 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1052 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1053
1054 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1055 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1056
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001057 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1058 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1059 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1060 designed to be used with a local log server.
1061
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001062 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1063 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1064 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1065 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1066 logger consumes.
1067
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001068 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1069 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1070 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1071 used with a local log server.
1072
1073 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1074 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1075 designed to be used with a local log server.
1076
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001077 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1078 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1079 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1080 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1081
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001082 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1083 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1084 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1085 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1086 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1087
1088 <sample_size>
1089 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1090 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1091 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1092 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1093 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1094
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001095 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001097 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1098 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1099 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1100
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001101 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1102 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1103 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1104 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001105
1106 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001107 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1108 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1109 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1110 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1111 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1112 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001114 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001116log-send-hostname [<string>]
1117 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1118 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1119 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1120 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1121 the logs.
1122
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001123log-tag <string>
1124 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1125 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1126 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001127 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001128
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001129lua-load <file>
1130 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1131 used multiple times.
1132
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001133lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1134 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1135 variable.
1136 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1137 to "path".
1138
1139 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1140 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1141 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1142 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1143 will be checked earlier.
1144
1145 As an example by specifying the following path:
1146
1147 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1148 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1149
1150 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1151 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1152 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1153 paths if that does not exist either.
1154
1155 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1156 documentation.
1157
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001158master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001159 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1160 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1161 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001162 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001163 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1164 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001165 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1166 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1167 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1168 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1169 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001170
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001171 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001172
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001173mworker-max-reloads <number>
1174 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001175 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001176 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1177 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1178 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1179
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001180nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001181 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1182 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1183 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001184 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1185 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001186 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1187 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1188 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001189
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001190nbthread <number>
1191 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001192 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1193 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1194 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1195 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1196 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001197 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1198 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1199 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1200 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1201 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1202 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1203 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001204
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001205pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001206 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1207 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1208 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1209 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001210
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001211pp2-never-send-local
1212 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1213 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1214 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1215 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1216 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1217 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1218 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1219 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1220 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1221 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1222 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1223
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001224presetenv <name> <value>
1225 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1226 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1227 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1228 and "unsetenv".
1229
1230resetenv [<name> ...]
1231 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1232 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1233 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1234 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1235 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1236 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1237 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1238 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1239
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001240stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001241 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1242 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1243 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1244 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1245 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1246 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001247 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001248 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1249 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1250 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1251 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001252
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001253server-state-base <directory>
1254 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001255 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1256 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001257
1258server-state-file <file>
1259 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1260 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1261 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1262 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1263 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1264 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1265 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1266 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001267 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1268 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001269
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001270setenv <name> <value>
1271 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1272 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1273 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1274 and "unsetenv".
1275
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001276set-dumpable
1277 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001278 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1279 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1280 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1281 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1282 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1283 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1284 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1285 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1286 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1287 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1288 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1289 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1290 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1291 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1292 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1293 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1294 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001295
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001296ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1298 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001299 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001300 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001301 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1302 information and recommendations see e.g.
1303 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1304 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1305 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1306 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001307
1308ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1310 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1311 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1312 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1313 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001314 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1315 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1316 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001317 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001318
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001319ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1320 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1321 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1322 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1323 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1324 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1325
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001326ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1327 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1328 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1329 keyword to see available options.
1330
1331 Example:
1332 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001333 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001334
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001335ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1337 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001338 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001339 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001340 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1341 information and recommendations see e.g.
1342 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1343 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1344 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1345 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1346 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001347
1348ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1350 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1351 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1352 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1353 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001354 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1355 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1356 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1357 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001358
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001359ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1360 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1361 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1362 keyword to see available options.
1363
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001364ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1365 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1366 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1367 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001368 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001369 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001370 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1371 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1372 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1373 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001374 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1375 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1376 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1377
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001378ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1379 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1380 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001381 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001382 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001383 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1384
1385 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001386
1387 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1388 and won't try to remove them.
1389
1390 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1391
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001392ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001393 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001394 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1395 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001396
1397 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1398 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1399 optimize the startup time.
1400
1401 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1402 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1403 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1404
1405 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001406 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001407
1408 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001409 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1410
1411 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1412 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1413 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1414 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1415 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1416 bind configuration..
1417
1418 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1419 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1420 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1421 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1422 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1423 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1424 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1425 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1426
1427 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1428
1429 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1430 a cert bundle.
1431
1432 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1433 separately in several "crt".
1434
1435 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1436 since files are loading separately.
1437
1438 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1439 required to commit them.
1440
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001441 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001442 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001443
1444 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1445
1446 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1447
1448 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1449 not provided in the PEM file.
1450
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001451 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1452 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1453
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001454 The default behavior is "all".
1455
1456 Example:
1457 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1458 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1459 ssl-load-extra-files none
1460
1461 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1462
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001463ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1464 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1465 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1466 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1467
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001468ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001469 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001470 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1471 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1472 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1473 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1474 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1475 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001476 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001477
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001478stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1479 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1480 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1481 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001482 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001483 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001484
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001485 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1486 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1487 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001488
1489stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1490 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1491 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001492 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001493
1494stats maxconn <connections>
1495 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1496 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001498uid <number>
1499 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1500 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1501 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1502 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1503
1504ulimit-n <number>
1505 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1506 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1507 option.
1508
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001509unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1510 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1511
1512 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1513 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1514 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1515 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1516 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1517 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1518 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1519 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1520 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1521 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1522
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001523unsetenv [<name> ...]
1524 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1525 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1526 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1527 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1528 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1529 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1530 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1531
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001532user <user name>
1533 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1534 See also "uid" and "group".
1535
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001536node <name>
1537 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1538
1539 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1540 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1541 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1542 traffic.
1543
1544description <text>
1545 Add a text that describes the instance.
1546
1547 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1548 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1549 "<" and ">" characters.
1550
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100155151degrees-data-file <file path>
1552 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001553 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001554
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001555 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001556 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1557
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000155851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001559 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1560 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1561 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1562
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001563 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001564 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1565
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200156651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001567 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1568 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1569
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001570 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1571 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1572
157351degrees-cache-size <number>
1574 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1575 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1576 By default, this cache is disabled.
1577
1578 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001579 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1580
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001581wurfl-data-file <file path>
1582 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1583 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1584
1585 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1586 with USE_WURFL=1.
1587
1588wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1589 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1590 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1591 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1592
1593 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1594
1595 Valid WURFL properties are:
1596 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1597
1598 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1599 device.
1600
1601 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1602 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1603
1604 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1605 particular web request.
1606
1607 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1608 used Libwurfl API version.
1609
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001610 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1611 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1612
1613 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1614 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1615
1616 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1617
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001618 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1619 with USE_WURFL=1.
1620
1621wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1622 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1623 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1624
1625 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1626 with USE_WURFL=1.
1627
1628wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1629 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1630 thus before the chroot.
1631
1632 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1633 with USE_WURFL=1.
1634
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001635wurfl-cache-size <size>
1636 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1637 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001638 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001639 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001640
1641 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1642 with USE_WURFL=1.
1643
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001644strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001645 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1646 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1647 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1648 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1649 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016513.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001652-----------------------
1653
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001654busy-polling
1655 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1656 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1657 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1658 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1659 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1660 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1661 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1662 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1663 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1664 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1665 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1666 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1667 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1668 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1669 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1670 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1671 "poll" pollers.
1672
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001673 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1674 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1675 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1676
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001677max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1678 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1679 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1680 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1681 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1682 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1683 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1684 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1685 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1686
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001687maxconn <number>
1688 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1689 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1690 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001691 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1692 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1693 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1694 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001695 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1696 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1697 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1698 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1699 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1700 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001702maxconnrate <number>
1703 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1704 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1705 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1706 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1707 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1708 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1709 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1710 fairness.
1711
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001712maxcomprate <number>
1713 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001714 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001715 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1716 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1717 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001718 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001719 default value.
1720
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001721maxcompcpuusage <number>
1722 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1723 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1724 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1725 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1726 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1727 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1728 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1729 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1730
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001731maxpipes <number>
1732 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1733 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1734 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1735 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1736 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1737 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1738
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001739maxsessrate <number>
1740 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1741 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1742 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1743 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1744 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1745 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1746 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1747 fairness.
1748
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001749maxsslconn <number>
1750 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1751 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1752 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1753 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1754 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1755 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1756 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001757 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1758 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1759 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1760 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1761 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1762 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1763 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001764
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001765maxsslrate <number>
1766 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1767 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1768 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1769 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1770 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1771 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1772 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1773 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1774 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1775 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1776
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001777maxzlibmem <number>
1778 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1779 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1780 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001781 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1782 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1783 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1784
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001785noepoll
1786 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1787 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001788 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001789
1790nokqueue
1791 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1792 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1793 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1794
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001795noevports
1796 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1797 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1798 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1799 also "nopoll".
1800
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001801nopoll
1802 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1803 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001804 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001805 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1806 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001807
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001808nosplice
1809 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001810 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001811 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001812 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001813 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1814 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1815 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1816 "option splice-response".
1817
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001818nogetaddrinfo
1819 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1820 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1821
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001822noreuseport
1823 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1824 command line argument "-dR".
1825
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001826profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1827 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1828 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1829 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1830 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001831 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001832 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1833 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1834 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1835 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1836
1837 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1838 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1839 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1840 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1841 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001842 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1843 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1844 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1845 CLI.
1846
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001847spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001848 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1849 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1850 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1851 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1852 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1853 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001854
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001855ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001856 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001857 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001858 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1859 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1860 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1861 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1862 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001863 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1864 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001865 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1866 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1867 openssl configuration file uses:
1868 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1869
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001870ssl-mode-async
1871 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001872 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001873 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1874 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1875 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001876 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001877 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001878
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001879tune.buffers.limit <number>
1880 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1881 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1882 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1883 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1884 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001885 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001886 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1887 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1888 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1889 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1890 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1891 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1892 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1893 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1894 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1895
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001896tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1897 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1898 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1899 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1900 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1901
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001902tune.bufsize <number>
1903 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1904 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1905 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1906 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1907 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1908 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1909 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001910 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1911 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1912 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001913 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001914 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1915 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1916 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001917
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001918tune.chksize <number>
1919 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1920 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1921 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1922 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1923 checks whenever possible.
1924
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001925tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1926 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1927 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1928 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1929 this value. The default value is 1.
1930
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001931tune.fail-alloc
1932 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1933 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1934 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1935 gracefully.
1936
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001937tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1938 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1939 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1940 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1941 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1942 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1943
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001944tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1945 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1946 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1947 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1948 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1949 change it.
1950
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001951tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1952 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001953 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1954 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001955 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1956 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1957 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1958 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1959 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1960
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001961tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1962 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1963 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1964 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1965 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1966 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1967 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1968 recommended not to change this value.
1969
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001970tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1971 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1972 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1973 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1974 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1975 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1976 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1977 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1978
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001979tune.http.cookielen <number>
1980 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1981 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1982 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1983 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1984 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1985 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1986 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1987 to change this value.
1988
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001989tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001990 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1991 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001992 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001993 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001994 configuration directives too.
1995 The default value is 1024.
1996
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001997tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1998 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1999 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2000 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2001 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2002 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2003 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002004 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2005 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2006 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002007
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002008tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2009 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2010 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2011 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2012 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2013 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2014 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2015 this option to "off". The default is on.
2016
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002017tune.idletimer <timeout>
2018 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2019 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2020 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2021 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2022 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2023 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002024 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002025 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002026 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2027
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002028tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2029 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2030 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2031 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2032 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2033 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2034 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2035 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2036 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2037 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2038
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002039tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2040 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002041 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002042 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2043 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002044 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002045 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2046 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2047
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002048tune.lua.maxmem
2049 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2050 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2051 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2052 memory.
2053
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002054tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2055 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002056 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2057 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002058 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002059
2060tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2061 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2062 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2063 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2064 check servers.
2065
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002066tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2067 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2068 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2069 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002070 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002071
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002072tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002073 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2074 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2075 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2076 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2077 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2078 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2079 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2080 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2081 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2082 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002083
2084tune.maxpollevents <number>
2085 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2086 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2087 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2088 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2089 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2090
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002091tune.maxrewrite <number>
2092 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2093 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2094 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2095 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2096 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2097 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2098 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2099 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2100 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2101 bufsize.
2102
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002103tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2104 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2105 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2106 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2107 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2108 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2109 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2110 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2111 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2112 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002113 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2114 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002115 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2116 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2117 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2118 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2119 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2120 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2121 setting this parameter to 0.
2122
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002123tune.pipesize <number>
2124 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2125 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2126 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2127 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2128 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2129 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2130
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002131tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2132 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2133 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2134 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2135 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2136 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2137 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002138 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002139
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002140tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2141 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2142 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2143 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2144 default is 20.
2145
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002146tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2147tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2148 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2149 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2150 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002151 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002152 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002153 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2154 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2155
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002156tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002157 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002158 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2159 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2160 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2161 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2162
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002163tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002164 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002165 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002166 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2167 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2168 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2169
2170tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2171 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2172 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2173 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2174 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2175 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2176 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2177 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2178 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2179 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002180
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002181tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2182tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2183 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2184 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2185 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002186 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002187 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002188 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2189 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2190 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2191 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2192 notifying haproxy again.
2193
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002194tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002195 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2196 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2197 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002198 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002199 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002200 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002201 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2202 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2203 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002204 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2205 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002206
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002207tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002208 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002209 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2210 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2211 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2212 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2213 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2214
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002215tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2216 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2217 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2218 performances. This is disabled by default.
2219
2220 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2221 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2222
2223 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2224
2225 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2226
2227 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2228
2229 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2230 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2231 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2232
2233 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2234 converted.
2235
2236 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2237 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2238 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2239 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2240 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2241 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2242 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002243 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2244 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002245
2246 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2247
2248 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2249 only need this line:
2250
2251 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2252
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002253tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2254 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002255 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002256 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2257 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2258 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2259 being used for too long.
2260
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002261tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2262 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2263 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2264 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2265 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2266 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2267 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2268 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2269 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2270 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2271 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002272 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002273 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002274
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002275tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2276 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2277 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2278 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2279 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002280 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002281 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2282 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002283 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2284 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002285
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002286tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2287 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2288 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2289 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2290 1000 entries.
2291
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002292tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2293 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2294 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2295 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2296
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002297tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002298tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002299tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2300tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2301tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002302 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2303 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2304 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2305 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2306 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2307 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2308 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2309 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002310
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002311 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2312 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2313 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2314 all available space is consumed.
2315 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2316 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2317 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002318
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002319tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2320 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002321 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002322 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002323 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002324 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2325
2326tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2327 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2328 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002329 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2330 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023323.3. Debugging
2333--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002334
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002335quiet
2336 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2337 line argument "-q".
2338
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002339zero-warning
2340 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2341 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2342 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2343 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2344 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2345 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2346
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002347
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010023483.4. Userlists
2349--------------
2350It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2351http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2352it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2353
2354userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002355 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002356 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2357
2358group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002359 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002360 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2361 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2362
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002363user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2364 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002365 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2366 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002367 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2368 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2369 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2370 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002371
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002372 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2373 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2374 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2375 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2376 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2377 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2378 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2379 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2380 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002381
2382 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002383 userlist L1
2384 group G1 users tiger,scott
2385 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002386
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002387 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2388 user scott insecure-password elgato
2389 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002390
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002391 userlist L2
2392 group G1
2393 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002394
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002395 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2396 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2397 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002398
2399 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002400
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002401
24023.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002403----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002404It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2405several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2406instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2407values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2408automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2409In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2410using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2411tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2412reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2413Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2414that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2415each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002416
2417peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002418 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002419 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2420
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002421bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2422 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2423 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2424
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002425disabled
2426 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2427 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2428 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2429
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002430default-bind [param*]
2431 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2432
2433default-server [param*]
2434 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2435
2436 Arguments:
2437 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2438 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2439 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2440 details.
2441
2442
2443 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2444
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002445enable
2446 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2447
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002448log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2449 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2450 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2451 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2452 more details.
2453
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002454peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002455 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2456 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002457 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2458 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2459 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2460 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2461 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002462
2463 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2464 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2465
2466 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002467 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2468 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2469 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002470
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002471 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2472 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002473
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002474 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2475 "server" keyword explanation below).
2476
2477server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002478 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002479 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2480 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2481 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2482 of this "peers" section).
2483 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2484
2485
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002486 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002487 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002488 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002489 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2490 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2491 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002492
2493 backend mybackend
2494 mode tcp
2495 balance roundrobin
2496 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2497 stick on src
2498
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002499 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2500 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002501
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002502 Example:
2503 peers mypeers
2504 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2505 default-server ssl verify none
2506 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2507 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002508
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002509
2510table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2511 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2512
2513 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2514 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002515 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002516 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2517 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2518 "stick-table" keyword).
2519
2520 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2521 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2522 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2523 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2524 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2525 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2526 of the stick-table name as follows:
2527
2528 peers mypeers
2529 peer A ...
2530 peer B ...
2531 table t1 ...
2532
2533 frontend fe1
2534 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2535
2536 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2537 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2538
2539 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2540 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2541 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2542 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2543 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2544 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2545 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2546
2547 peers mypeers
2548 peer A ...
2549 peer B ...
2550 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2551
2552 backend t1
2553 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2554
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002555 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002556 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2557 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2558
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025593.6. Mailers
2560------------
2561It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2562If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2563in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2564
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002565mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002566 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2567 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2568
2569mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2570 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2571
2572 Example:
2573 mailers mymailers
2574 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2575 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2576
2577 backend mybackend
2578 mode tcp
2579 balance roundrobin
2580
2581 email-alert mailers mymailers
2582 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2583 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2584
2585 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2586 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2587
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002588timeout mail <time>
2589 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2590 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2591 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2592 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2593
2594 Example:
2595 mailers mymailers
2596 timeout mail 20s
2597 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002598
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025993.7. Programs
2600-------------
2601In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2602master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2603managed the same way as the workers.
2604
2605During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2606sequence as a worker:
2607
2608 - the master is re-executed
2609 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2610 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2611 instance of the program
2612
2613During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2614
2615program <name>
2616 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2617 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2618 the management guide).
2619
2620command <command> [arguments*]
2621 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2622 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2623 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2624 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2625
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002626user <user name>
2627 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2628 See also "group".
2629
2630group <group name>
2631 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2632 See also "user".
2633
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002634option start-on-reload
2635no option start-on-reload
2636 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2637 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2638 program section.
2639
2640
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010026413.8. HTTP-errors
2642----------------
2643
2644It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2645imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2646several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2647
2648http-errors <name>
2649 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2650 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2651
2652errorfile <code> <file>
2653 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2654
2655 Arguments :
2656 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002657 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2658 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002659
2660 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2661 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2662 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2663 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2664 before any chroot is performed.
2665
2666 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2667
2668 Example:
2669 http-errors website-1
2670 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2671 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2672 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2673
2674 http-errors website-2
2675 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2676 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2677 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2678
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026793.9. Rings
2680----------
2681
2682It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2683servers or traces.
2684
2685ring <ringname>
2686 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2687
2688description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002689 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002690 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2691
2692format <format>
2693 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2694
2695 Arguments:
2696 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2697 one of the following :
2698
2699 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2700 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2701 designed to be used with a local log server.
2702
2703 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2704 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2705 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2706 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2707 is the default.
2708
2709 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2710 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2711
2712 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2713 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2714
2715 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2716 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2717 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2718 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2719 logger consumes.
2720
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002721 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2722 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2723 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2724 with a local log server.
2725
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002726 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2727 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2728 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2729 used with a local log server.
2730
2731maxlen <length>
2732 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2733 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2734 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2735
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002736server <name> <address> [param*]
2737 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2738 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2739 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2740 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2741 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2742 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2743 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2744 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2745 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002746 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2747 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002748
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002749size <size>
2750 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2751 set to BUFSIZE.
2752
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002753timeout connect <timeout>
2754 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2755
2756 Arguments :
2757 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2758 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2759 as explained at the top of this document.
2760
2761timeout server <timeout>
2762 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2763
2764 Arguments :
2765 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2766 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2767 as explained at the top of this document.
2768
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002769 Example:
2770 global
2771 log ring@myring local7
2772
2773 ring myring
2774 description "My local buffer"
2775 format rfc3164
2776 maxlen 1200
2777 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002778 timeout connect 5s
2779 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002780 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002781
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020027823.10. Log forwarding
2783-------------------
2784
2785It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
2786haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
2787
2788log-forward <name>
2789 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
2790
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002791backlog <conns>
2792 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2793 on connections accept.
2794
2795bind <addr> [param*]
2796 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02002797 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
2798 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
2799 syslog protocol over TCP.
2800 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002801 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
2802
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02002803dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002804 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
2805 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
2806 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
2807 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02002808 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002809
2810log global
2811log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2812 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2813 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
2814 documentation.
2815 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
2816 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
2817 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
2818 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
2819 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
2820
2821 Example:
2822 global
2823 log stderr format iso local7
2824
2825 ring myring
2826 description "My local buffer"
2827 format rfc5424
2828 maxlen 1200
2829 size 32764
2830 timeout connect 5s
2831 timeout server 10s
2832 # syslog tcp server
2833 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
2834
2835 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002836 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
2837 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002838 # all messages on stderr
2839 log global
2840 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
2841 log ring@myring local0
2842 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
2843 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
2844 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
2845 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
2846 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002847
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002848maxconn <conns>
2849 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
2850 10 is the default.
2851
2852timeout client <timeout>
2853 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028554. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002856----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002857
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002858Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002859 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002860 - frontend <name>
2861 - backend <name>
2862 - listen <name>
2863
2864A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2865its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2866section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002867section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002868
2869A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2870connections.
2871
2872A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2873to forward incoming connections.
2874
2875A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2876parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2879'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2880case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2881
2882Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2883logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2884proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2885However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2886name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2887
2888Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2889and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002890bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2892modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2893arbitrary criteria.
2894
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002895In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2896a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002897the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002898
2899 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2900 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2901 between responses and new requests.
2902
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002903 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2904 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2905 client-facing connection remains open.
2906
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002907 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2908 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002909
2910The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2911frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2912following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002913weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002914
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002915 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002916
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002917 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2918 ----+-----+-----+----
2919 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2920 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002921 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2922 ----+-----+-----+----
2923 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029274.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2928--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002930The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2931limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2932they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2933limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002934marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002935option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002936and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2937with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2938specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002940
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002941 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2942------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2943acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002944backlog X X X -
2945balance X - X X
2946bind - X X -
2947bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002948capture cookie - X X -
2949capture request header - X X -
2950capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002951clitcpka-cnt X X X -
2952clitcpka-idle X X X -
2953clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002954compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002955cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002956declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002957default-server X - X X
2958default_backend X X X -
2959description - X X X
2960disabled X X X X
2961dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002962email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002963email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002964email-alert mailers X X X X
2965email-alert myhostname X X X X
2966email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002967enabled X X X X
2968errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002969errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002970errorloc X X X X
2971errorloc302 X X X X
2972-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2973errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002974force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002975filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002976fullconn X - X X
2977grace X X X X
2978hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002979http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002980http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002981http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002982http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002983http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002984http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002985http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002986http-check set-var X - X X
2987http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002988http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002989http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002990http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002991http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002992http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002993id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002994ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002995load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002996log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002997log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002998log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002999log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003000max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003001maxconn X X X -
3002mode X X X X
3003monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003004monitor-uri X X X -
3005option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3006option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3007option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3008option allbackups (*) X - X X
3009option checkcache (*) X - X X
3010option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3011option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003012option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003013option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3014option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003015-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3016option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003017option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3018option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003019option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003020option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003021option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003022option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003023option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003024option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3025option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3026option httpchk X - X X
3027option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003028option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003029option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003030option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003031option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003032option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003033option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3034option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3035option logasap (*) X X X -
3036option mysql-check X - X X
3037option nolinger (*) X X X X
3038option originalto X X X X
3039option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003040option pgsql-check X - X X
3041option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003042option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003043option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003044option smtpchk X - X X
3045option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3046option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3047option splice-request (*) X X X X
3048option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003049option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003050option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3051option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3052-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003053option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003054option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3055option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3056option tcpka X X X X
3057option tcplog X X X X
3058option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003059external-check command X - X X
3060external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003061persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3062rate-limit sessions X X X -
3063redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003064-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003065retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003066retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003067server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003068server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003069server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003070source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003071srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3072srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3073srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003074stats admin - X X X
3075stats auth X X X X
3076stats enable X X X X
3077stats hide-version X X X X
3078stats http-request - X X X
3079stats realm X X X X
3080stats refresh X X X X
3081stats scope X X X X
3082stats show-desc X X X X
3083stats show-legends X X X X
3084stats show-node X X X X
3085stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003086-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3087stick match - - X X
3088stick on - - X X
3089stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003090stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003091stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003092tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003093tcp-check connect X - X X
3094tcp-check expect X - X X
3095tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003096tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003097tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003098tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003099tcp-check set-var X - X X
3100tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003101tcp-request connection - X X -
3102tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003103tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003104tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003105tcp-response content - - X X
3106tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003107timeout check X - X X
3108timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003109timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003110timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003111timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3112timeout http-request X X X X
3113timeout queue X - X X
3114timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003115timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003116timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003117timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003118transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003119unique-id-format X X X -
3120unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003121use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003122use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003123use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003124------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3125 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003126
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031284.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3129---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130
3131This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3132
3133
3134acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3135 Declare or complete an access list.
3136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3137 no | yes | yes | yes
3138 Example:
3139 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3140 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3141 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003143 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144
3145
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003146backlog <conns>
3147 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3149 yes | yes | yes | no
3150 Arguments :
3151 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3152 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003153 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003154
3155 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3156 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3157 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3158 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3159 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3160 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3161 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3162 backlog parameter.
3163
3164 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3165 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3166 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3167
3168 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3169
3170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003171balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003172balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003173 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3175 yes | no | yes | yes
3176 Arguments :
3177 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3178 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3179 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3180 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3181
3182 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3183 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3184 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3185 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003186 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003187 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003188 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3189 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3190 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3191 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3192 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3193 it, so that you don't worry.
3194
3195 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3196 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3197 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3198 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3199 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3200 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3201 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3202 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003203
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003204 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3205 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3206 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3207 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3208 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3209 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3210 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003211 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3212 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3213 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003214
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003215 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003216 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003217 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3218 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003219 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003220 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3221 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3222 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3223 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3224 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003225 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3226 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3227 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3228 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3229 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3230 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003231
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003232 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3233 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3234 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3235 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3236 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3237 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3238 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3239 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003240 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003241 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003242 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3243 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3244 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003245
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003246 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3247 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3248 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3249 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3250 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3251 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3252 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3253 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3254 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3255 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3256 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3257 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003258
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003259 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003260 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3261 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3262 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3263 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3264 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3265 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3266 URIs start with a leading "/".
3267
3268 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3269 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3270 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3271 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3272
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003273 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3274 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3275 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3276 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3277
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003278 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003279 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3280
3281 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003282 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3283 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003284 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3285 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3286 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3287 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003288 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003289 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3290 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003291
3292 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3293 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3294 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3295 server will receive the request.
3296
3297 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3298 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3299 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3300 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3301 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003302 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3303 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3304 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003305
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003306 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3307 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3308 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3309 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3310 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003312 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003313 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3314 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3315 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3316
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003317 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3318 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3319 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3320
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003321 random
3322 random(<draws>)
3323 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003324 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3325 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3326 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3327 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003328 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3329 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3330 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3331 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3332 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3333 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3334 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3335 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3336 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3337 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3338 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3339 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3340 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3341 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3342 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3343 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3344 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3345 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3346 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3347 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003348
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003349 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003350 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003351 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3352 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3353 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3354 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3355 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3356 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003357 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003358 used instead.
3359
3360 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3361 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3362 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3363 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3364
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003365 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3366 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3367 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3368
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003369 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003371 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003372 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3373 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003374
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003375 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3376 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3377 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003378
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003379 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003380 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003381 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3382 NTLM relies on.
3383
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384 Examples :
3385 balance roundrobin
3386 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003387 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003388 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3389 balance hdr(host)
3390 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003391
3392 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3393 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003395 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003396 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3397 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3398 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003399 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003400
3401 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3402 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3403 defaults to 16 kB.
3404
3405 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3406 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3407
3408 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3409 Round Robin.
3410
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003411 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003412 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3413 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3414 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3415
3416 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3417
3418 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003419 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003420 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3421 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3422 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003423
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003424 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425
3426
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003427bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3428bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003429 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3431 no | yes | yes | no
3432 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003433 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3434 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3435 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3436 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003437 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003438 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3439 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3440 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3441 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3442 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3443 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003444 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003445 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3446 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003447 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003448 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3449 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003450 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003451 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3452 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003453 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003454 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3455 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3456 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3457 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3458 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3459 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3460 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003461 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3462 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3463 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003464 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3465 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3466 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3467 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003468 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3469 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3470 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003471
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003472 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3473 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003474 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3475 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3476 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003477 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3478 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3479 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3480 the range.
3481
3482 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3483 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3484 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3485 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3486 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3487 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3488 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003489 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003490 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003492 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003493 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003494 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3495 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3496 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3497 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3498 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3499 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3500
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003501 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3502 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3503 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3504 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003506 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3507 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3508 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3509 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3510 in a frontend.
3511
3512 Example :
3513 listen http_proxy
3514 bind :80,:443
3515 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003516 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003518 listen http_https_proxy
3519 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003520 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003521
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003522 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3523 bind ipv6@:80
3524 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3525 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3526
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003527 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003528 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003529
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003530 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3531 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3532 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3533 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3534 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3535
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003536 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003537 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003538
3539
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003540bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003541 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3543 yes | yes | yes | yes
3544 Arguments :
3545 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3546 may be used to override a default value.
3547
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003548 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003549 option may be combined with other numbers.
3550
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003551 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003552 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3553 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3554 missing from all processes.
3555
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003556 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003557 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003558 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3559 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3560 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3561 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3562 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003563 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003564
3565 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3566 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3567 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3568 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3569 and 'even' instances.
3570
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003571 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3572 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3573 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3574 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003575
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003576 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3577 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3578
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003579 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3580 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3581 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3582
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003583 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3584 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3585
3586 Example :
3587 listen app_ip1
3588 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003589 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003590
3591 listen app_ip2
3592 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003593 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003594
3595 listen management
3596 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003597 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003598
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003599 listen management
3600 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3601 bind-process 1-4
3602
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003603 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003604
3605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003606capture cookie <name> len <length>
3607 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3609 no | yes | yes | no
3610 Arguments :
3611 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3612 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3613 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3614 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003615 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003616
3617 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3618 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3619 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3620 right if it exceeds <length>.
3621
3622 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3623 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3624 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3625 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3626
3627 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3628 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3629 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3630
3631 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3632 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3633 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003634 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3635 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3636 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003637
3638 Example:
3639 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3640
3641 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003642 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003643
3644
3645capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003646 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3648 no | yes | yes | no
3649 Arguments :
3650 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003651 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003652 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3653 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3654 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3655
3656 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3657 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3658 it exceeds <length>.
3659
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003660 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003661 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3662 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003663 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3664 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3665 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3666 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003667 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003668 environments to find where the request came from.
3669
3670 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3671 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3672 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3673 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003675 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3676 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3677 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3678 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3679 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003680
3681 Example:
3682 capture request header Host len 15
3683 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003684 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003686 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687 about logging.
3688
3689
3690capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003691 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3693 no | yes | yes | no
3694 Arguments :
3695 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003696 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003697 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3698 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3699 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3700
3701 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3702 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3703 it exceeds <length>.
3704
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003705 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003706 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3707 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3708 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003709 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3710 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3711 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3712 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003713
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003714 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3715 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3716 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3717 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3718 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003719
3720 Example:
3721 capture response header Content-length len 9
3722 capture response header Location len 15
3723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003724 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003725 about logging.
3726
3727
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003728clitcpka-cnt <count>
3729 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3730 the connection on the client side.
3731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3732 yes | yes | yes | no
3733 Arguments :
3734 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3735
3736 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3737 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003738 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3739 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003740
3741 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3742
3743
3744clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3745 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3746 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3747 client side.
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | yes | yes | no
3750 Arguments :
3751 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3752 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3753 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3754 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3755
3756 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3757 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003758 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3759 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003760
3761 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3762
3763
3764clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3765 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3767 yes | yes | yes | no
3768 Arguments :
3769 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3770 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3771 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3772 document.
3773
3774 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
3775 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003776 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3777 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003778
3779 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
3780
3781
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003782compression algo <algorithm> ...
3783compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003784compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003785 Enable HTTP compression.
3786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3787 yes | yes | yes | yes
3788 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003789 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3790 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3791 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3792
3793 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003794 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3795 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3796 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003797
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003798 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003799 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003800
3801 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3802 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3803 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3804 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3805 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003806 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003807
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003808 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3809 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3810 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3811 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3812 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3813 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3814 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003815 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003816
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003817 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003818 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003819 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3820 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3821 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3822 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3823 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003824
3825 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3826 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3827 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3828 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3829 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003830 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3831 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3832 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3833 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3834 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003835 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3836 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003837
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003838 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003839 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3840 "Accept-Encoding" header
3841 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003842 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003843 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3844 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3845 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3846 "multipart"
3847 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3848 header
3849 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3850 and later
3851 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3852 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003853 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003854
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003855 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003856
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003857 Examples :
3858 compression algo gzip
3859 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003860
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003861
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003862cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003863 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3864 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003865 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003866 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3868 yes | no | yes | yes
3869 Arguments :
3870 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3871 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3872 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3873 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3874 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3875 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003876 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003877 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3878 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3879
3880 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3881 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3882 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3883 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3884 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3885 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003886 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3887 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003888 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003889 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3890 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003891
3892 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003893 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003894
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003895 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003896 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003897 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003898 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003899 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3900 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3901 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3902 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3903 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3904 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3905 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003906
3907 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3908 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3909 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3910 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3911 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3912 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3913 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3914 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3915 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003916 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003917 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3918 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3919 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003920
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003921 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3922 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3923 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003924 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3925 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3926 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3927 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003928 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3929 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3930 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003931
3932 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3933 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3934 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3935 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3936 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3937 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3938 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3939 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3940 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3941
3942 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3943 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3944 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3945 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3946 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3947 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3948 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3949 persistence cookie in the cache.
3950 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3951
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003952 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3953 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3954 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3955 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3956 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003957 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003958 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3959 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3960 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3961 they logout.
3962
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003963 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3964 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3965 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3966 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3967
3968 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3969 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3970 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3971 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3972 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3973 this attribute.
3974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003975 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003976 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003977 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3978 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3979 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3980 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3981 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3982 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003983
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003984 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3985 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3986 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3987 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3988 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3989 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3990 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3991 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003992 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003993 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3994 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3995 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3996 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3997 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3998 the site.
3999
4000 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4001 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4002 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4003 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4004 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4005 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4006 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4007 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4008 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4009 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4010 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4011 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4012 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004013 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004014 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4015 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4016
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004017 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4018 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4019 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4020 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4021 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4022 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4023
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004024 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4025 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4026 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4027 repeated.
4028
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004029 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4030 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4031 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4032 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004034 Examples :
4035 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4036 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4037 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004038 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004039
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004040 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004041
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004042
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004043declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4044 Declares a capture slot.
4045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4046 no | yes | yes | no
4047 Arguments:
4048 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4049
4050 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4051 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4052 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4053 for use in the response.
4054
4055 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004056 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004057 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4058
4059
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004060default-server [param*]
4061 Change default options for a server in a backend
4062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4063 yes | no | yes | yes
4064 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004065 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4066 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4067 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4068 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004069
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004070 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004071 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4072
4073 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004074
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004075
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004076default_backend <backend>
4077 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 yes | yes | yes | no
4080 Arguments :
4081 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4082
4083 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4084 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4085 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4086 will catch all undetermined requests.
4087
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004088 Example :
4089
4090 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4091 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4092 default_backend dynamic
4093
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004094 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004096
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004097description <string>
4098 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4100 no | yes | yes | yes
4101 Arguments : string
4102
4103 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4104 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4105 it describes.
4106 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4107
4108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004109disabled
4110 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4112 yes | yes | yes | yes
4113 Arguments : none
4114
4115 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4116 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4117 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4118 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4119 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4120 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4121 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4122
4123 See also : "enabled"
4124
4125
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004126dispatch <address>:<port>
4127 Set a default server address
4128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4129 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004130 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004131
4132 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4133 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4134 during start-up.
4135
4136 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4137 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4138 possible with normal servers.
4139
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004140 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004141 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4142 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4143 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4144 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4145
4146 See also : "server"
4147
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004148
4149dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4150 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4152 yes | no | yes | yes
4153 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4154
4155 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004156 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004157 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4158 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004159 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004160 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004161
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004162enabled
4163 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4165 yes | yes | yes | yes
4166 Arguments : none
4167
4168 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4169 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4170
4171 See also : "disabled"
4172
4173
4174errorfile <code> <file>
4175 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4177 yes | yes | yes | yes
4178 Arguments :
4179 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004180 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004181 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004182
4183 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004184 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004185 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004186 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4187 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004188
4189 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4190 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4191 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4192
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004193 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4194
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004195 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4196 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4197 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4198 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4199 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4200 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4201 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4202 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4203 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004205 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4206 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4207 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004208 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004209 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4210
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004211 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004213 Example :
4214 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004215 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004216 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4217 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4218
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004219
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004220errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4221 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4222 section.
4223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4224 yes | yes | yes | yes
4225 Arguments :
4226 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4227
4228 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004229 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004230 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004231
4232 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4233 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4234 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4235 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4236 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004237 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004238 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4239
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004240 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4241 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004242
4243 Example :
4244 errorfiles generic
4245 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4246
4247
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004248errorloc <code> <url>
4249errorloc302 <code> <url>
4250 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 yes | yes | yes | yes
4253 Arguments :
4254 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004255 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004256 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004257
4258 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4259 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4260 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4261 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004262 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004263
4264 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4265 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4266 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4267
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004268 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4269
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004270 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4271 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4272 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4273 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004274 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004275 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4276 request.
4277
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004278 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004279
4280
4281errorloc303 <code> <url>
4282 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4284 yes | yes | yes | yes
4285 Arguments :
4286 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004287 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004288 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004289
4290 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4291 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4292 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4293 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004294 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004295
4296 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4297 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4298 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4299
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004300 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4301
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004302 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4303 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4304 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4305 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004306 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004307
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004308 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004309
4310
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004311email-alert from <emailaddr>
4312 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004313 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004314 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4315 yes | yes | yes | yes
4316
4317 Arguments :
4318
4319 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4320
4321 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4322 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4323
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004324 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004325 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4326 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004327
4328
4329email-alert level <level>
4330 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4331 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4332 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4333 yes | yes | yes | yes
4334
4335 Arguments :
4336
4337 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4338 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4339 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4340
4341 By default level is alert
4342
4343 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4344 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4345 for the proxy.
4346
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004347 Alerts are sent when :
4348
4349 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4350 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4351 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4352 is notice or lower
4353 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4354 and a health check status update occurs
4355
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004356 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4357 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004358 section 3.6 about mailers.
4359
4360
4361email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4362 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4363 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4364 yes | yes | yes | yes
4365
4366 Arguments :
4367
4368 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4369
4370 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4371 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4372
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004373 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4374 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004375
4376
4377email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4378 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4379 mailers.
4380 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4381 yes | yes | yes | yes
4382
4383 Arguments :
4384
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004385 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004386
4387 By default the systems hostname is used.
4388
4389 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4390 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4391 for the proxy.
4392
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004393 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4394 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004395
4396
4397email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004398 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004399 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4400 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4401 yes | yes | yes | yes
4402
4403 Arguments :
4404
4405 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4406
4407 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4408 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4409
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004410 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004411 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4412
4413
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004414force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4415 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4416 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004417 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004418
4419 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4420 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4421 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4422 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4423 marked down for maintenance operations.
4424
4425 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4426 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4427 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4428 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4429 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4430 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4431 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4432 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4433 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4434
4435 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4436 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4437 is used.
4438
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004439 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004440 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004441
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004442
4443filter <name> [param*]
4444 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4446 no | yes | yes | yes
4447 Arguments :
4448 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4449 referenced in section 9.
4450
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004451 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004452 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004453 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4454 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004455
4456 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4457 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4458
4459 Example:
4460 listen
4461 bind *:80
4462
4463 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4464 filter compression
4465 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4466
4467 compression algo gzip
4468 compression offload
4469
4470 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4471
4472 See also : section 9.
4473
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004474
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004475fullconn <conns>
4476 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4478 yes | no | yes | yes
4479 Arguments :
4480 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4481 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4482
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004483 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004484 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004485 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004486 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4487 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4488 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4489 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4490 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004491 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004492
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004493 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4494 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004495 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4496 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4497 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004498
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004499 Example :
4500 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4501 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4502 # connections.
4503 backend dynamic
4504 fullconn 10000
4505 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4506 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4507
4508 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4509
4510
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004511grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004512 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004514 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004515 Arguments :
4516 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4517 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4518 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4519
4520 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4521 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004522 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004523 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4524
4525 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4526 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4527 simplify it.
4528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004529
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004530hash-balance-factor <factor>
4531 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4533 yes | no | no | yes
4534 Arguments :
4535 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4536 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004537 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004538
4539 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4540 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4541 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4542 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4543 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4544 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4545 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4546
4547 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4548 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4549 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4550 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4551 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4552
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004553 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4554 consistent hashing mechanism.
4555
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004556 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4557
4558
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004559hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004560 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4562 yes | no | yes | yes
4563 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004564 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4565 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004566
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004567 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4568 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4569 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4570 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4571 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4572 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4573 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4574 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4575 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4576 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004577
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004578 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4579 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4580 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4581 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4582 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4583 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4584 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4585 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4586 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4587 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4588 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4589 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4590 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004591 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4592 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004593
4594 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4595
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004596 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004597 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4598 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4599 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004600 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4601 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4602 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004603
4604 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4605 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004606 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4607 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4608 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4609 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4610
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004611 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4612 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4613 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4614 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4615 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4616 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4617 parameter.
4618
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004619 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4620 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4621 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4622 used on strings.
4623
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004624 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4625
4626 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4627 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4628 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4629 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4630 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4631 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4632 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4633 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4634 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4635 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4636 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4637 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004638
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004639 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4640 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4641 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004642
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004643 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004644
4645
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004646http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4647 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4648 ones).
4649
4650 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4651 no | yes | yes | yes
4652
4653 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4654 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4655 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4656 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4657 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4658 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4659
4660 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4661 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4662 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4663
4664 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4665 below.
4666
4667 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4668 instance.
4669
4670 Example:
4671 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4672 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4673 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4674
4675http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4676
4677 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4678 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4679 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4680 example, or to pass some internal information.
4681 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4682 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4683 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4684
4685http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4686
4687 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4688 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4689
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004690http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004691
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004692 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4693 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4694 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4695 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4696 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004697
4698http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4699 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4700
4701 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4702
4703 Example:
4704 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4705
4706 # applied to:
4707 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4708
4709 # outputs:
4710 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4711
4712 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4713
4714http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4715 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4716
4717 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4718
4719 Example:
4720 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4721
4722 # applied to:
4723 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4724
4725 # outputs:
4726 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4727
4728http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4729
4730 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4731 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4732 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4733
4734http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4735 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4736
4737 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4738 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4739 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4740 fallback.
4741
4742 Example:
4743 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4744 http-response set-status 431
4745 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4746 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4747
4748http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4749
4750 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4751 inline.
4752
4753 Arguments:
4754 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4755 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4756 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4757 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4758 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4759 (request and response)
4760 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4761 processing
4762 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4763 processing
4764 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4765 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4766 and '_'.
4767
4768 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4769 followed by some converters.
4770
4771 Example:
4772 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4773
4774http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4775
4776 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4777 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4778 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4779 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4780 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004781 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004782 processing.
4783
4784 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4785 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004786 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004787 rules evaluation.
4788
4789http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4790
4791 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4792 details about <var-name>.
4793
4794 Example:
4795 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4796
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004797
4798http-check comment <string>
4799 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4800 it fails.
4801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4802 yes | no | yes | yes
4803
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004804 Arguments :
4805 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4806 rule fails.
4807
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004808 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4809 user-friendly error reporting.
4810
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004811 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004812 "http-check expect".
4813
4814
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004815http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4816 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004817 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004818 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4820 yes | no | yes | yes
4821
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004822 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004823 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4824
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004825 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004826 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004827
4828 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4829 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4830 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4831 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4832
4833 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4834
4835 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4836
4837 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4838
4839 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4840
4841 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4842
4843 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4844 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4845 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4846 is used.
4847
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004848 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4849 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4850 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4851 haproxy -vv.
4852
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004853 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4854
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004855 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4856 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4857 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4858 different ports or with different servers.
4859
4860 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4861 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4862 the port with a "http-check connect".
4863
4864 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4865 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4866 do.
4867
4868 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4869 unset-var or comment rules.
4870
4871 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004872 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4873 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4874 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4875 option httpchk
4876
4877 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004878 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004879 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004880 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004881 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004882 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004883
4884 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4885
4886 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004887
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004888
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004889http-check disable-on-404
4890 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004892 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004893 Arguments : none
4894
4895 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4896 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4897 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4898 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4899 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4900 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4901 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4902 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004903 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4904 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4905 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4906
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004907 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004908
4909
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004910http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004911 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4912 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4913 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004914 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004916 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004917
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004918 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004919 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4920
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004921 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4922 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4923 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4924 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4925 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4926 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4927 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4928 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4929 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4930 result is always conclusive.
4931
4932 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4933 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4934 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004935 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4936 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4937 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4938 example 404 with disable-on-404
4939 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4940 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4941 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004942
4943 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4944 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004945 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4946 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4947 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4948 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4949 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4950 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004951
4952 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4953 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004954 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4955 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4956 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4957 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004958 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4959
4960 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4961 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4962 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4963 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4964
4965 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4966 informational message reported in logs if an error
4967 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4968 log-format string.
4969
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004970 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004971 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4972 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004973 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4974 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4975 details on the supported keywords.
4976
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004977 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4978 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4979 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4980 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004981
4982 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4983 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4984 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4985 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4986 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4987
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004988 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4989 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4990 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4991 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4992 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4993 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4994 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004995
4996 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004997 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004998 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4999 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5000 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5001 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5002
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005003 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5004 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005005 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5006 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5007 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5008 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5009 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5010 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5011 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5012 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005013 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5014 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5015 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5016 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5017 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5018 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5019 insensitive on the header names.
5020
5021 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5022 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5023 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5024 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5025 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5026 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005027
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005028 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005029 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005030 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5031 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5032 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5033 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5034 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005035 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005036 trace).
5037
5038 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005039 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005040 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5041 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5042 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5043 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5044 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005045 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005046
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005047 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5048 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5049 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5050 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5051 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5052 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5053
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005054 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
5055 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
5056 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5057 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5058 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5059 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5060 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5061 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5062
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005063 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5064 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5065 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5066 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5067 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005068
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005069 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5070 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5071
5072 Examples :
5073 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005074 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005075
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005076 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5077 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5078
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005079 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005080 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005081
5082 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005083 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005084
5085 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005086 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005087
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005088 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005089 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005090
5091
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005092http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005093 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5094 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005095 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5096 health checks.
5097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5098 yes | no | yes | yes
5099 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005100 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5101
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005102 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5103 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5104 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5105 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5106 to invent non-standard ones.
5107
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005108 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5109 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5110 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5111 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5112
5113 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5114 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5115 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5116 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005117
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005118 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005119 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005120 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005121 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5122 to add it.
5123
5124 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5125 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5126 to the log-format rules.
5127
5128 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5129 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5130 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005131
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005132 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5133 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5134 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5135 request.
5136
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005137 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5138 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5139 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005140 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5141 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5142 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5143 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005144 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005145 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005146 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5147
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005148 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5149 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005150 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5151 so, it will be ignored.
5152
5153 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5154 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5155 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5156 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5157 configured request authority.
5158
5159 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5160 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005161
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005162 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005163
5164
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005165http-check send-state
5166 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5168 yes | no | yes | yes
5169 Arguments : none
5170
5171 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5172 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5173 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5174 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5175 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5176
5177 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5178 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5179 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5180 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5181 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005182 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5183 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5184 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5185
5186 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5187 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5188 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5189
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005190 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5191 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5192 checked in multiple backends.
5193
5194 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5195 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5196
5197 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5198 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5199 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5200 one fails.
5201
5202 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5203 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5204 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5205
5206 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5207 server's queue.
5208
5209 Example of a header received by the application server :
5210 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5211 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5212
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005213 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5214 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005215
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005216
5217http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005218 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005219 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5220 yes | no | yes | yes
5221
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005222 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005223 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5224 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5225 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5226 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5227 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5228 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5229 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5230 and '-'.
5231
5232 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5233
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005234 Examples :
5235 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005236
5237
5238http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005239 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005240 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5241 yes | no | yes | yes
5242
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005243 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005244 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5245 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5246 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5247 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5248 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5249 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5250 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5251 and '-'.
5252
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005253 Examples :
5254 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005256
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005257http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5258 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5259 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5260 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5261 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5263 yes | yes | yes | yes
5264 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005265 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005266 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005267 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5268 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005269
5270 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5271 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5272 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5273 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5274
5275 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5276 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5277 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5278 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5279
5280 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5281 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5282 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5283 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5284 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5285 chroot is performed.
5286
5287 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5288 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5289 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5290 considered.
5291
5292 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5293 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5294 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5295 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5296 considered as a raw string.
5297
5298 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5299 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5300 "content-type".
5301
5302 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5303 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5304 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5305 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5306 evaluated as a log-format string.
5307
5308 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5309 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5310 argument to "content-type".
5311
5312 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5313 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5314 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5315 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5316
5317 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5318 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5319 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5320 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5321 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5322 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5323 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5324 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5325
5326 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5327 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5328 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5329
5330 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5331 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5332
5333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005334http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005335 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5336
5337 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5338 no | yes | yes | yes
5339
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005340 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5341 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5342 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5343 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5344 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005346 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5347 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005349 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005351 Example:
5352 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5353 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5354 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005356 http-request allow if nagios
5357 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5358 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5359 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005361 Example:
5362 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5363 acl add path /addacl
5364 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005366 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005368 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5369 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005371 Example:
5372 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5373 acl setmap path /setmap
5374 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005376 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005378 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5379 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005381 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5382 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005384http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005386 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5387 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5388 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5389 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5390 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5391 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5392 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5393 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005395http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005397 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5398 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5399 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5400 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5401 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5402 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5403 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5404 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005406http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005408 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5409 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005410
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005412http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005414 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5415 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5416 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5417 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5418 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005419
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005420 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5421 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5422 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5423 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5424 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5425 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5426 instead.
5427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005428 Example:
5429 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5430 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005431
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005432http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005433
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005434 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005436http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5437 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005439 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5440 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5441 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5442 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5443 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5444 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5445 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5446 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5447 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005448
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005449 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5450 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5451 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005452 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5453
5454 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5455 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5456 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5457 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005459http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005460
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005461 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5462 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5463 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5464 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5465 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5466 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005467
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005468http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005469
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005470 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5471 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5472 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5473 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5474 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005476http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005477
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005478 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5479 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5480 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5481 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5482 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5483 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005484
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005485http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5486http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5487 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5488 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5489 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5490 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005491
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005492 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5493 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5494 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005495 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005496 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5497 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5498 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005499 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005500 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005501
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005502http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5503 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5504 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5505 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5506
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005507http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5508
5509 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5510 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5511 pointed by <resolvers>.
5512 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5513 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5514 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5515 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5516 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5517 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5518 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5519 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5520 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5521 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5522 to 0.0.0.0.
5523
5524 Example:
5525 resolvers mydns
5526 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5527 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5528 timeout retry 1s
5529 hold valid 10s
5530 hold nx 3s
5531 hold other 3s
5532 hold obsolete 0s
5533 accepted_payload_size 8192
5534
5535 frontend fe
5536 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5537 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5538 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5539
5540 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5541 # which mean DNS resolution error
5542 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5543
5544 default_backend be
5545
5546 backend b_503
5547 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5548 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5549 # 503 error page to end users
5550
5551 backend be
5552 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5553 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5554 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5555 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5556 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5557
5558 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5559 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5560
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005561http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5562
5563 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5564 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5565 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5566 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005567 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5568 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005569
5570 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005572http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005574 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5575 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5576 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5577 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5578 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005580http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005582 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5583 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5584 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5585 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005587http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5588 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005589
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005590 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005591 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5592 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5593 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5594 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5595 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005596
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005597 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5598 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5599 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5600 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5601 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005602
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005603 Example:
5604 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5605
5606 # applied to:
5607 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5608
5609 # outputs:
5610 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5611
5612 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005613
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005614 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5615
5616 # applied to:
5617 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005618
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005619 # outputs:
5620 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005621
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005622http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5623 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5624
5625 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5626 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005627 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5628 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5629 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005630
5631 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5632 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5633 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5634
5635 Example:
5636 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5637 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5638
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005639 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5640 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5641 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5642 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5643
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005644http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5645 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5646
5647 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5648 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5649 query-string are replaced.
5650
5651 Example:
5652 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5653 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5654
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005655http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5656 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5657
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005658 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5659 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5660 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5661 against.
5662
5663 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5664 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5665 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005666
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005667 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5668 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5669 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5670 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5671 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5672 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5673 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5674 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5675 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005676 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5677 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005678
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005679 Example:
5680 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5681 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005682
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005683 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5684 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005686http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5687 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005688
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005689 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5690 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5691 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5692 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005693
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005694 Example:
5695 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005696
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005697 # applied to:
5698 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005699
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005700 # outputs:
5701 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005702
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005703http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5704 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5705 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005706 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005707 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5708
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005709 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005710 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5711 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005712 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005713 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005714 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005715 are followed to create the response :
5716
5717 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5718 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5719 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5720 ignored.
5721
5722 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5723 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005724 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005725 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5726 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005727
5728 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5729 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5730 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005731 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005732 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005733
5734 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5735 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5736 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005737 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005738 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5739 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005740
5741 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5742 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5743 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5744 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5745 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5746 as a raw content.
5747
5748 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5749 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5750 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5751 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5752 considered as a raw string.
5753
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005754 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005755 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5756 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5757 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5758
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005759 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5760 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005761 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005762
5763 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5764
5765 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005766 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005767 if { path /ping }
5768
5769 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5770 if { path /favicon.ico }
5771
5772 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5773 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5774 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5775
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005776http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5777http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005778
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005779 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5780 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5781 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005782
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005783http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5784 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005785
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005786 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5787 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5788 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5789 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005791http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005793 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5794 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5795 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5796 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5797 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005799 Arguments:
5800 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5801 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005803 Example:
5804 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5805 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005807 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5808 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005810http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005812 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5813 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5814 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005815
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005816 Arguments:
5817 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5818 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005820 Example:
5821 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5822 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005823
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005824 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5825 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5826 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005827
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005828http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005829
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005830 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5831 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5832 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5833 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5834 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005835
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005836 Example:
5837 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5838 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5839 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5840 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5841 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5842 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5843 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5844 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5845 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005846
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005847http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005848
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005849 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5850 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5851 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5852 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5853 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005854
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005855http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5856 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005857
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005858 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5859 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5860 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5861 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5862 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5863 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5864 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5865 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5866 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005867
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005868http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005870 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5871 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5872 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5873 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5874 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5875 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5876 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005878http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005879
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005880 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5881 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5882 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005883
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005884http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005885
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005886 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5887 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5888 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5889 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5890 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5891 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5892 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5893 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005894
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005895http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005896
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005897 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5898 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5899 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5900 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5901 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5902 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005904 Example :
5905 # prepend the host name before the path
5906 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005907
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005908http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5909
5910 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
5911 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
5912 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
5913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005914http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005916 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5917 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5918 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5919 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5920 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005921
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005922http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005923
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005924 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5925 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5926 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5927 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5928 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5929 values have higher priority.
5930 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5931 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5932 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5933 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5934 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005935
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005936http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005937
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005938 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5939 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5940 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5941 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5942 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5943 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5944 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005946 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005947
5948 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005949 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5950 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005952http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5953 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5954 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5955 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005956 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5957 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005958
5959 Arguments :
5960 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5961 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005962
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005963 See also "option forwardfor".
5964
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005965 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005966 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5967 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5968
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005969 # After the masking this will track connections
5970 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5971 http-request track-sc0 src
5972
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005973 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5974 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5975
5976http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5977
5978 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5979 expression.
5980
5981 Arguments:
5982 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5983 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005984
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005985 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005986 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5987 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5988
5989 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5990 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5991 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5992
5993http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5994
5995 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5996 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5997 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5998 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5999 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6000 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6001 information from the request.
6002
6003 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6004
6005http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6006
6007 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6008 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6009 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6010 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6011 path and the query string.
6012 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6013
6014http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6015
6016 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6017 inline.
6018
6019 Arguments:
6020 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6021 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6022 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6023 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6024 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6025 (request and response)
6026 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6027 processing
6028 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6029 processing
6030 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6031 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6032 and '_'.
6033
6034 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6035 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006036
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006037 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006038 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006040http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6041 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6044 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6045 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6046 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6047 agent name must be used.
6048
6049 Arguments:
6050 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6051
6052 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6053 configuration.
6054
6055http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6056
6057 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6058 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6059 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6060 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6061 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6062 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6063 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6064 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6065 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6066 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6067 action.
6068 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6069 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6070 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6071 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6072 you fully understand how it works.
6073
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006074http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6075
6076 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6077 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6078 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6079 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6080 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006081 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006082 processing.
6083
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006084 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006085 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6086 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6087 rules evaluation.
6088
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006089http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6090http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6091 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6092 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6093 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6094 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006095
6096 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6097 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6098 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006099 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6100 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6101 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6102 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6103 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6104 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6105 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6106 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6107 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6108 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006109 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006110 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6111 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6112 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6113 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6114 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006115
6116http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6117http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6118http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6119
6120 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6121 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6122 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6123 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006124 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006125 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6126 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6127 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6128 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6129 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6130 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6131 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6132
6133 Arguments :
6134 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6135 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6136 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6137 select which table entry to update the counters.
6138
6139 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6140 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6141 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6142 that table until the session ends.
6143
6144 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6145 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6146 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6147 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6148 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6149 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6150 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6151 useful information.
6152
6153 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6154 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6155 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6156 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6157 checks that make use of it.
6158
6159http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6160
6161 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006162
6163 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006164 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006165
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006166http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6167
6168 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6169 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6170 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6171 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6172 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6173 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6174
6175 Arguments :
6176 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6177
6178 Example:
6179 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006181http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006183 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6184 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6185 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006186
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006188http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006189 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6190
6191 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6192 no | yes | yes | yes
6193
6194 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6195 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6196 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6197 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6198 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6199 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6200
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006201 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6202 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006203
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006204 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006205
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006206 Example:
6207 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006208
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006209 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006211 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6212 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006214 Example:
6215 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006216
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006217 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006219 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6220 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006222 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6223 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006224
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006225http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006226
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006227 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6228 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6229 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6230 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6231 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6232 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6233 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6234 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006235
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006236http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006237
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006238 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6239 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6240 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6241 example, or to pass some internal information.
6242 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6243 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6244 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006245
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006246http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006248 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6249 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006250
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006251http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006252
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006253 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006254
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006255http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006256
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006257 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6258 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6259 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6260 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6261 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6262 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6263 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006264
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006265 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6266 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6267 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6268 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6269 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006270
6271 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6272 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6273 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6274 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006275
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006276http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006277
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006278 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6279 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6280 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6281 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6282 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6283 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006284
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006285http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006286
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006287 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6288 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6289 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6290 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6291 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006292
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006293http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006294
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006295 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6296 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6297 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6298 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6299 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6300 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006301
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006302http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6303http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6304 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6305 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6306 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6307 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006308
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006309 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6310 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6311 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006312 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006313 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6314 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6315 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006316 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006317 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006318
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006319http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006320
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006321 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6322 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6323 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6324 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6325 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6326 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006327
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006328http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6329 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006330
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006331 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6332 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006333
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006334 Example:
6335 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006336
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006337 # applied to:
6338 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006339
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006340 # outputs:
6341 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006342
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006343 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006344
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006345http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6346 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006347
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006348 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006349 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006350
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006351 Example:
6352 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006353
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006354 # applied to:
6355 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006356
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006357 # outputs:
6358 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006359
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006360http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6361 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6362 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006363 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6365
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006366 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006367 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6368 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006369 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006370 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006371 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006372 are followed to create the response :
6373
6374 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6375 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6376 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6377 ignored.
6378
6379 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6380 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006381 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006382 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6383 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006384
6385 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6386 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6387 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006388 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006389 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006390
6391 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6392 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6393 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006394 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006395 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6396 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006397
6398 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6399 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6400 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6401 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6402 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6403 as a raw content.
6404
6405 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6406 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6407 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6408 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6409 considered as a raw string.
6410
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006411 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6412 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6413 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6414 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6415
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006416 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6417 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006418 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006419
6420 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6421
6422 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006423 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006424 if { status eq 404 }
6425
6426 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6427 string "This is the end !" \
6428 if { status eq 500 }
6429
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006430http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6431http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006432
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006433 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6434 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6435 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006436
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006437http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6438 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006439
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006440 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6441 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6442 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6443 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006444
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006445http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006446
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006447 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6448 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6449 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6450 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6451 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006452
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006453 Arguments:
6454 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006455
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006456 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6457 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006458
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006459http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006460
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006461 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6462 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6463 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006464
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006465http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6466
6467 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6468 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6469 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6470 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6471 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6472
6473http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6474
6475 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6476 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6477 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6478 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6479 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6480 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6481 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6482 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6483 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6484
6485http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6486
6487 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6488 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6489 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6490 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6491 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6492 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6493 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6494
6495http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6496
6497 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6498 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6499 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6500 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6501 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6502 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6503 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6504 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6505
6506http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6507 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6508
6509 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6510 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6511 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6512 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006513
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006514 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006515 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6516 http-response set-status 431
6517 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6518 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006519
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006520http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006521
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006522 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6523 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6524 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6525 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6526 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6527 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6528 based on some information from the request.
6529
6530 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6531
6532http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6533
6534 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6535 inline.
6536
6537 Arguments:
6538 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6539 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6540 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6541 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6542 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6543 (request and response)
6544 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6545 processing
6546 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6547 processing
6548 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6549 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6550 and '_'.
6551
6552 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6553 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006554
6555 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006556 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006557
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006558http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006559
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006560 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6561 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6562 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6563 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6564 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6565 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6566 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6567 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6568 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6569 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6570 action.
6571 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6572 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6573 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6574 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6575 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006576
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006577http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6578
6579 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6580 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6581 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6582 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6583 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006584 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006585 processing.
6586
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006587 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006588 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006589 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006590 rules evaluation.
6591
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006592http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6593http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6594http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006595
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006596 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6597 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6598 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6599 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6600 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6601 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6602
6603http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6604
6605 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6606 about <var-name>.
6607
6608 Example:
6609 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6610
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006611
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006612http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6613 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6614
6615 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6616 yes | no | yes | yes
6617
6618 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006619 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6620 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6621 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006622
6623 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6624
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006625 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6626 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6627 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6628 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6629 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6630 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6631 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6632 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6633 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6634 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006635
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006636 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6637 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6638 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6639 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6640 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6641 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6642 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006643 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6644 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6645 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6646 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6647 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6648 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006649
6650 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6651 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6652 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6653 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6654 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6655 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6656 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6657 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006658 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006659 downsides of rare connection failures.
6660
6661 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6662 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6663 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6664 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6665 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6666 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006667 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006668 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6669 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6670 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6671 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6672 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6673
6674 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006675 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6676 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6677 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006678
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006679 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6680 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6681 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006682
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006683 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6684 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006685
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006686 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006687
6688 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6689 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6690 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6691
6692 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6693
6694
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006695http-send-name-header [<header>]
6696 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006697 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6698 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006699 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006700 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6701
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006702 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6703 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6704 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6705 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6706 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6707 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6708 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6709 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6710 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6711 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6712 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6713 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6714 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6715 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6716 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6717 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006718
6719 See also : "server"
6720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006721id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006722 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6724 no | yes | yes | yes
6725 Arguments : none
6726
6727 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6728 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6729 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006730
6731
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006732ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6733 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6734 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006735 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006736
6737 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6738 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6739 and running).
6740
6741 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6742 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6743 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006744 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006745 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6746
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006747 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6748 "unless" condition is met.
6749
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006750 Example:
6751 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6752 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6753 ignore-persist if url_static
6754
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006755 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6756
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006757load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6758 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6759 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6760 yes | no | yes | yes
6761
6762 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6763 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6764 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006765 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006766 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6767 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6768 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6769 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006771 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006772 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006773 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006774
6775 Arguments:
6776 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6777 named "server-state-file".
6778
6779 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6780 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6781 name is used as a file name.
6782
6783 none don't load any stat for this backend
6784
6785 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006786 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6787 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6788 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006789 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006790 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006791
6792 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6793 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6794
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006795 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006796
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006797 global
6798 stats socket /tmp/socket
6799 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006800
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006801 defaults
6802 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006803
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006804 backend bk
6805 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6806 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006807
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006808
6809 Then one can run :
6810
6811 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6812
6813 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6814
6815 1
6816 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6817 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6818 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6819
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006820 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006821
6822 global
6823 stats socket /tmp/socket
6824 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6825
6826 defaults
6827 load-server-state-from-file local
6828
6829 backend bk
6830 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6831 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6832
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006833
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006834 Then one can run :
6835
6836 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6837
6838 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6839
6840 1
6841 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6842 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6843 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6844
6845 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6846 "show servers state"
6847
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006849log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006850log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6851 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006852no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006853 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6855 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006856
6857 Prefix :
6858 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6859 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6860 prefix does not allow arguments.
6861
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006862 Arguments :
6863 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6864 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6865 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6866 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6867 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6868 parameter.
6869
6870 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6871 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6872
6873 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6874 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6875 standard syslog port).
6876
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006877 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6878 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6879 standard syslog port).
6880
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006881 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6882 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6883 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006884 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006885
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006886 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6887 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6888 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6889 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6890 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6891 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6892 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6893 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6894 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6895 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6896 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6897 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6898 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6899 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6900 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6901 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006902 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6903 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006904
6905 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6906 and "fd@2", see above.
6907
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006908 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6909 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6910 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6911 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6912 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6913 having the logs instantly available.
6914
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006915 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6916 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006917
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006918 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6919 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6920 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6921 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6922 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6923 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6924 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6925 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6926 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6927 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006928 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006929
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006930 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6931 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6932 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6933 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6934 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6935
6936 <sample_size>
6937 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6938 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6939 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6940 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6941 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6942
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006943 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6944 one of the following :
6945
6946 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6947 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6948
6949 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6950 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6951
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006952 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
6953 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
6954 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6955 designed to be used with a local log server.
6956
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006957 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6958 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6959 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6960 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6961 systemd logger consumes.
6962
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006963 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6964 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
6965 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
6966 used with a local log server.
6967
6968 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
6969 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6970 designed to be used with a local log server.
6971
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006972 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6973 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6974 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6975 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6976
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006977 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6978
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006979 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6980 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6981 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6982
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006983 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6984 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6985 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6986 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006987
6988 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6989 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6990 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006991 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6992 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6993 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6994 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6995 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006996
6997 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6998
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006999 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7000 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7001 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007002
7003 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7004 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7005 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7006 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7007
7008 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7009 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007010
7011 Example :
7012 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007013 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7014 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7015 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007016 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7017 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007018 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007019
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007020
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007021log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007022 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7023 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7024 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007025
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007026 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7027 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7028 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7029 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7030 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007031
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007032 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7033 "option httplog" directives.
7034
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007035log-format-sd <string>
7036 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7037 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7038 yes | yes | yes | no
7039
7040 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7041 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7042 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7043 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7044 which covers the log format string in depth.
7045
7046 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7047 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7048
7049 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7050 log format to "rfc5424".
7051
7052 Example :
7053 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7054
7055
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007056log-tag <string>
7057 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7058 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7059 yes | yes | yes | yes
7060
7061 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7062 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7063 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7064 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7065 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7066 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7067 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7068 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7069 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007070
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007071max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7072 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7073 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7074 yes | no | yes | yes
7075
7076 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7077 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7078 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7079 servers.
7080
7081 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7082 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7083 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7084 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7085 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007086 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007087 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7088 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7089 picking a different server.
7090
7091 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7092 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7093 even if they have to be queued.
7094
7095 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7096 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7097
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007098max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7099 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7100 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7101 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007102
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007103maxconn <conns>
7104 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7106 yes | yes | yes | no
7107 Arguments :
7108 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7109 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7110 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7111 closes.
7112
7113 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7114 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7115 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7116 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007117 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7118 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7119 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7120 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007121
7122 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7123 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7124 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7125
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007126 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7127 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007128
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007129 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7130
7131
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007132mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007133 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7135 yes | yes | yes | yes
7136 Arguments :
7137 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7138 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7139 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7140 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7141
7142 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7143 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7144 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7145 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7146 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7147
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007148 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7149 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7150 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007151
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007152 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007153 defaults http_instances
7154 mode http
7155
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007156
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007157monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007158 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7160 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007161 Arguments :
7162 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7163 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007164 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007165 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7166 backend and its backup.
7167
7168 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7169 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7170 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7171 servers in a list of backends.
7172
7173 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7174 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7175 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7176 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7177 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7178 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7179 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007180 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7181 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007182
7183 Example:
7184 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007185 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007186 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7187 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7188 monitor-uri /site_alive
7189 monitor fail if site_dead
7190
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007191 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007192
7193
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007194monitor-uri <uri>
7195 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7197 yes | yes | yes | no
7198 Arguments :
7199 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7200 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7201
7202 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7203 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7204 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7205 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7206 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7207 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7208 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7209 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7210
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007211 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007212 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7213 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7214 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7215 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7216 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7217 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007218
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007219 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7220 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7221 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7222 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007224 Example :
7225 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7226 frontend www
7227 mode http
7228 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7229
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007230 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007231
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007232
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007233option abortonclose
7234no option abortonclose
7235 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7237 yes | no | yes | yes
7238 Arguments : none
7239
7240 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7241 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7242 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7243 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007244 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007245 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7246 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7247 encountered while delivering the response.
7248
7249 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7250 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7251 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7252 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7253 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7254 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007255 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007256 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007257 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007258 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7259 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7260 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7261
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007262 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7263 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007264 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7265 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7266 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7267 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7268 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7269 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007270 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007271
7272 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7273 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7274
7275 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7276
7277
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007278option accept-invalid-http-request
7279no option accept-invalid-http-request
7280 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7282 yes | yes | yes | no
7283 Arguments : none
7284
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007285 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007286 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007287 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007288 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7289 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7290 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7291 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7292 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007293 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7294 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7295 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7296 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007297 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007298 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007299 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7300 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7301 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007302
7303 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7304 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7305 been confirmed.
7306
7307 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7308 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007309 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7310 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007311 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7312
7313 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7314 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7315
7316 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7317 stats socket.
7318
7319
7320option accept-invalid-http-response
7321no option accept-invalid-http-response
7322 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7324 yes | no | yes | yes
7325 Arguments : none
7326
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007327 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007328 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007329 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007330 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7331 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7332 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7333 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7334 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007335 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7336 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7337 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007338
7339 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7340 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7341 been confirmed.
7342
7343 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7344 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7345 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7346 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7347
7348 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7349 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7350
7351 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7352 stats socket.
7353
7354
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007355option allbackups
7356no option allbackups
7357 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7359 yes | no | yes | yes
7360 Arguments : none
7361
7362 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7363 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7364 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7365 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7366 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7367 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7368 order between the backup servers anymore.
7369
7370 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7371 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7372
7373 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7374 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7375
7376
7377option checkcache
7378no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007379 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7381 yes | no | yes | yes
7382 Arguments : none
7383
7384 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7385 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007386 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007387 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7388 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007389 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007390
7391 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007392 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007393 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007394 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7395 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007396 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007397 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007398 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7399 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007400 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007401 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7402 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007403 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007404 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7405 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7406 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7407 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7408 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7409 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7410 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7411 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7412 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7413
7414 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007415 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7416 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7417 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7418 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007419
7420 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7421 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007422 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007423 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007424
7425 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7426 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7427
7428
7429option clitcpka
7430no option clitcpka
7431 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7433 yes | yes | yes | no
7434 Arguments : none
7435
7436 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7437 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007438 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007439 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7440
7441 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7442 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7443 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7444 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7445
7446 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7447 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7448 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7449 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7450 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7451
7452 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7453
7454 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7455 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7456 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7457
7458 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7459 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7460
7461 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7462
7463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007464option contstats
7465 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7467 yes | yes | yes | no
7468 Arguments : none
7469
7470 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7471 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7472 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7473 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007474 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7475 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7476 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7477 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7478 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007479
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007480option disable-h2-upgrade
7481no option disable-h2-upgrade
7482 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7483 connection.
7484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7485 yes | yes | yes | no
7486 Arguments : none
7487
7488 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7489 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7490 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7491 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7492 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7493 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7494 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7495 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7496
7497 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7498 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007499
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007500option dontlog-normal
7501no option dontlog-normal
7502 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7504 yes | yes | yes | no
7505 Arguments : none
7506
7507 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7508 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7509 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7510 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7511 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7512 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7513 logged.
7514
7515 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7516 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7517 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007519 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007520 logging.
7521
7522
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007523option dontlognull
7524no option dontlognull
7525 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7527 yes | yes | yes | no
7528 Arguments : none
7529
7530 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7531 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7532 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7533 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7534 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7535 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007536 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7537 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7538 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007539
7540 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007541 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007542 would not be logged.
7543
7544 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7545 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7546
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007547 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007548 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007549
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007550
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007551option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007552 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7554 yes | yes | yes | yes
7555 Arguments :
7556 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7557 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007558 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007559 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007560
7561 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7562 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7563 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7564 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7565 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7566 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7567 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007568 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7569 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7570 possible that the client has already brought one.
7571
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007572 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007573 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007574 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007575 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007576 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007577 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007578
7579 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7580 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7581 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7582 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7583 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7584 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7585 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7586
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007587 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7588 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7589 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7590 are under the control of the end-user.
7591
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007592 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007593 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7594 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007595 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7596 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7597 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007598
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007599 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007600 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7601 frontend www
7602 mode http
7603 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7604
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007605 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7606 backend www
7607 mode http
7608 option forwardfor header X-Client
7609
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007610 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007611 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007612
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007613
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007614option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7615no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7616 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7618 yes | yes | yes | no
7619 Arguments : none
7620
7621 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7622 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7623 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7624 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7625 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7626 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7627 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7628
7629 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7630 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7631 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7632 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7633 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7634 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7635 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7636 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7637 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7638 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7639
7640 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7641
7642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7644
7645 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7646 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7647
7648
7649option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7650no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7651 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7653 yes | no | yes | yes
7654 Arguments : none
7655
7656 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7657 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7658 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7659 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7660 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7661 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7662 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7663
7664 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7665 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7666 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7667 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7668 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7669 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7670 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7671 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7672 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7673 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7674
7675 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7676
7677 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7678 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7679
7680 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7681 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7682
7683
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007684option http-buffer-request
7685no option http-buffer-request
7686 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7688 yes | yes | yes | yes
7689 Arguments : none
7690
7691 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7692 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7693 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7694 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7695 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7696 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007697 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7698 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7699 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7700 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007701
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007702 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007703
7704
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007705option http-ignore-probes
7706no option http-ignore-probes
7707 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7709 yes | yes | yes | no
7710 Arguments : none
7711
7712 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7713 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7714 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7715 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7716 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7717 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7718 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7719 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7720 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007721 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7722 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007723 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7724
7725 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7726 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7727 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7728 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7729 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7730 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7731 are often the only way to detect them.
7732
7733 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7734 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7735
7736 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7737
7738
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007739option http-keep-alive
7740no option http-keep-alive
7741 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7743 yes | yes | yes | yes
7744 Arguments : none
7745
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007746 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7747 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007748 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7749 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007750 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7751 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7752 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007753
7754 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7755 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007756 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7757 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7758 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7759 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7760 situations where this option may be useful :
7761
7762 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007763 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007764
7765 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7766 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7767
7768 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7769 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7770 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7771 request.
7772
7773 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7774 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007775 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7776 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7777 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007778
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007779 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7780 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7781 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7782 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7783 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7784 not set.
7785
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007786 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7787 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7788 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007789
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007790 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007791 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007792 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007793
7794
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007795option http-no-delay
7796no option http-no-delay
7797 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7799 yes | yes | yes | yes
7800 Arguments : none
7801
7802 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7803 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7804 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7805 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7806 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7807 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7808 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7809 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7810 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7811 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7812 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7813 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7814 affected.
7815
7816 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7817 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7818 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7819 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7820 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7821 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7822 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7823 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7824 latency environments.
7825
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007826 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7827
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007828
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007829option http-pretend-keepalive
7830no option http-pretend-keepalive
7831 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007833 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007834 Arguments : none
7835
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007836 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007837 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7838 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7839 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7840 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7841 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7842 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7843 consider the response complete.
7844
7845 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7846 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7847 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7848 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007849 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007850 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7851
7852 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7853 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7854 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7855 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7856 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7857 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7858 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7859
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007860 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7861 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7862 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7863 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7864 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7865 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007866
7867 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7868 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7869
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007870 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007871 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007872
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007873
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007874option http-server-close
7875no option http-server-close
7876 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7878 yes | yes | yes | yes
7879 Arguments : none
7880
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007881 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7882 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7883 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7884 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007885 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7886 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7887 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7888 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7889 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7890 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7891 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7892 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7893 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7894 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7895 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007896
7897 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7898 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7899 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7900 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007901 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7902 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007903
7904 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7905 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007906 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7907 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7908 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007909
7910 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7911 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7912
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007913 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7914 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007915
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007916option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007917no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007918 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7920 yes | yes | yes | no
7921 Arguments : none
7922
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007923 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007924 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7925 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7926 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7927 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7928 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7929 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7930
7931 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7932 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007933 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7934 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7935 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007936
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007937 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7938 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7939 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7940 front of an existing proxy.
7941
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007942 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7943
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007944 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007945
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007946option httpchk
7947option httpchk <uri>
7948option httpchk <method> <uri>
7949option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007950 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7952 yes | no | yes | yes
7953 Arguments :
7954 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7955 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7956 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7957 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7958 ones.
7959
7960 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7961 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7962 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7963
7964 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7965 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7966 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007967 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007968
7969 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7970 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7971 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7972 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7973 the lack of any response.
7974
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007975 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7976 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7977 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7978 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7979
7980 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7981 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7982 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007983
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007984 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7985 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007986 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007987 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007988 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007989
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007990 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7991 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7992 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7993 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7994
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007995 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007996 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7997 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7998 backend https_relay
7999 mode tcp
8000 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8001 http-check send hdr Host www
8002 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008003
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008004 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8005 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8006 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008007
8008
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008009option httpclose
8010no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008011 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8013 yes | yes | yes | yes
8014 Arguments : none
8015
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008016 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8017 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8018 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8019 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008020 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008021
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008022 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8023 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008024 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008025 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8026 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008027
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008028 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8029 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8030 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008031
8032 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8033 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008034 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8035 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8036 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008037
8038 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8039 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8040
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008041 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008042
8043
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008044option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008045 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008047 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008048 Arguments :
8049 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8050 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8051 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008052 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008053 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008054
8055 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8056 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8057 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8058 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8059 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8060 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8061 ports.
8062
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008063 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8064 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008065
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008066 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008068 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008069
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008070
8071option http_proxy
8072no option http_proxy
8073 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8075 yes | yes | yes | yes
8076 Arguments : none
8077
8078 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8079 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8080 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8081 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8082 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8083
8084 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8085 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008086 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8087 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008088
8089 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8090 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8091
8092 Example :
8093 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8094 backend direct_forward
8095 option httpclose
8096 option http_proxy
8097
8098 See also : "option httpclose"
8099
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008100
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008101option independent-streams
8102no option independent-streams
8103 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8105 yes | yes | yes | yes
8106 Arguments : none
8107
8108 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8109 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8110 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8111 receive data or not.
8112
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008113 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008114 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8115 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8116 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8117 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8118 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8119 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8120 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8121 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8122 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8123 socket buffers.
8124
8125 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8126 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8127 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8128 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8129 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8130
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008131 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008132
8133
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008134option ldap-check
8135 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8137 yes | no | yes | yes
8138 Arguments : none
8139
8140 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8141 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8142 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8143 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8144
8145 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8146 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8147
8148 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8149 configure it.
8150
8151 Example :
8152 option ldap-check
8153
8154 See also : "option httpchk"
8155
8156
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008157option external-check
8158 Use external processes for server health checks
8159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8160 yes | no | yes | yes
8161
8162 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8163 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8164 command".
8165
8166 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8167
8168 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8169
8170
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008171option log-health-checks
8172no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008173 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8175 yes | no | yes | yes
8176 Arguments : none
8177
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008178 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8179 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8180 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008181
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008182 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8183 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8184 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8185 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8186 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8187
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008188 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008189 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008190
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008191 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8192 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8193 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008194
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008195
8196option log-separate-errors
8197no option log-separate-errors
8198 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8200 yes | yes | yes | no
8201 Arguments : none
8202
8203 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8204 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8205 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8206 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8207 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8208 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8209 provides very important information.
8210
8211 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8212 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8213 error logs.
8214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008215 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008216 logging.
8217
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008218
8219option logasap
8220no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008221 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8223 yes | yes | yes | no
8224 Arguments : none
8225
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008226 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8227 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8228 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8229 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8230
8231 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8232 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8233 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8234 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8235 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008236 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008237 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8238 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8239 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8240 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008241 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008242
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008243 Examples :
8244 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8245 mode http
8246 option httplog
8247 option logasap
8248 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8249
8250 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8251 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8252 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8253 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008255 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008256 logging.
8257
8258
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008259option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008260 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8262 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008263 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008264 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8265 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008266 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8267 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008268
8269 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8270 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008271 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008272 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8273 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8274 in the MySQL table, like this :
8275
8276 USE mysql;
8277 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8278 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8279
8280 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008281 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008282 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8283 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8284 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8285 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8286 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8287 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8288 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8289
8290 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8291 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008292
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008293 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008294
8295 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8296 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8297 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8298 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008299 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8300 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008301
8302 See also: "option httpchk"
8303
8304
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008305option nolinger
8306no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008307 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008308 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8309 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008310 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008311
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008312 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008313 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8314 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8315 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8316 connections.
8317
8318 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8319 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008320 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8321 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8322 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8323 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8324 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8325 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8326 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8327 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8328 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8329 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8330 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8331 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8332 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008333
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008334 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8335 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8336 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8337 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8338 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008339
8340 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8341 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008342 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8343 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8344 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008345
8346 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8347 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8348
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008349 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8350 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008351
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008352option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8353 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8355 yes | yes | yes | yes
8356 Arguments :
8357 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8358 matching <network>
8359 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8360 header name.
8361
8362 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8363 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8364 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8365 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8366 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8367 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8368 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8369 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8370 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8371 possible that the client has already brought one.
8372
8373 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8374 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8375 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8376 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8377 header and requires different one.
8378
8379 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8380 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8381 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8382 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8383 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8384 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8385 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8386
8387 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8388 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8389 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8390 both are defined.
8391
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008392 Examples :
8393 # Original Destination address
8394 frontend www
8395 mode http
8396 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8397
8398 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8399 backend www
8400 mode http
8401 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8402
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008403 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008404
8405
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008406option persist
8407no option persist
8408 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8409 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8410 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008411 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008412
8413 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8414 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8415 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8416 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8417 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8418 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8419 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8420 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8421 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8422 redirected to another valid server.
8423
8424 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8425 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8426
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008427 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008428
8429
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008430option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8431 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8433 yes | no | yes | yes
8434 Arguments :
8435 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8436 PostgreSQL server.
8437
8438 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8439 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8440 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8441 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8442
8443 See also: "option httpchk"
8444
8445
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008446option prefer-last-server
8447no option prefer-last-server
8448 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8449 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8450 yes | no | yes | yes
8451 Arguments : none
8452
8453 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8454 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8455 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8456 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8457 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8458 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8459 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8460 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8461 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008462 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8463 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008464 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8465 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8466 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008467 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8468 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8469 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008470
8471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8473
8474 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8475
8476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008477option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008478option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008479no option redispatch
8480 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8481 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8482 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008483 Arguments :
8484 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8485 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8486 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008487 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008488 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008489 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008490 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8491 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8492 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8493
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008494
8495 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8496 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8497 be able to access the service anymore.
8498
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008499 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8500 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008501
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008502 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8503 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8504 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8505 following order:
8506
8507 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8508
8509 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8510 list, or
8511
8512 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8513
8514 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8515 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8516
8517 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8518 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8519 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8520 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8521
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008522 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008523 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8524 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008525
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008526 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8527 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8528
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008529 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008530
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008531
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008532option redis-check
8533 Use redis health checks for server testing
8534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8535 yes | no | yes | yes
8536 Arguments : none
8537
8538 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8539 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8540 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8541 find the "+PONG" response message.
8542
8543 Example :
8544 option redis-check
8545
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008546 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008547
8548
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008549option smtpchk
8550option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8551 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8553 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008554 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008555 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008556 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008557 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8558
8559 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8560 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8561 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8562
8563 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8564 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8565 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8566 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8567 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8568 dead server.
8569
8570 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8571 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008572 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008573 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8574
8575 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8576 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8577 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8578 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008579 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008580
8581 Example :
8582 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8583
8584 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8585
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008587option socket-stats
8588no option socket-stats
8589
8590 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8592 yes | yes | yes | no
8593
8594 Arguments : none
8595
8596
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008597option splice-auto
8598no option splice-auto
8599 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8601 yes | yes | yes | yes
8602 Arguments : none
8603
8604 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8605 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008606 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008607 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008608 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008609 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8610 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8611 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8612 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8613
8614 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8615 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8616 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8617 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8618 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8619 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8620 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8621 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8622 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8623 keyword.
8624
8625 Example :
8626 option splice-auto
8627
8628 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8629 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8630
8631 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8632 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8633
8634
8635option splice-request
8636no option splice-request
8637 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8639 yes | yes | yes | yes
8640 Arguments : none
8641
8642 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008643 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008644 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8645 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8646 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8647 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8648
8649 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8650
8651 Example :
8652 option splice-request
8653
8654 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8655 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8656
8657 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8658 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8659
8660
8661option splice-response
8662no option splice-response
8663 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8665 yes | yes | yes | yes
8666 Arguments : none
8667
8668 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008669 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008670 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8671 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8672 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8673 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8674
8675 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8676
8677 Example :
8678 option splice-response
8679
8680 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8681 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8682
8683 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8684 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8685
8686
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008687option spop-check
8688 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8690 no | no | no | yes
8691 Arguments : none
8692
8693 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8694 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8695 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8696 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8697
8698 Example :
8699 option spop-check
8700
8701 See also : "option httpchk"
8702
8703
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008704option srvtcpka
8705no option srvtcpka
8706 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8708 yes | no | yes | yes
8709 Arguments : none
8710
8711 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8712 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008713 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008714 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8715
8716 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8717 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8718 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8719 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8720
8721 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8722 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8723 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8724 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8725 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8726
8727 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8728
8729 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8730 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8731 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8732
8733 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8734 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8735
8736 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8737
8738
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008739option ssl-hello-chk
8740 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8742 yes | no | yes | yes
8743 Arguments : none
8744
8745 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8746 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8747 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8748 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8749 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8750 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8751 hello message.
8752
8753 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8754 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8755 messages, which is appreciable.
8756
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008757 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8758 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8759 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008760
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008761 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8762
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008763
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008764option tcp-check
8765 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8766 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8767 yes | no | yes | yes
8768
8769 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8770 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8771
8772 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8773 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8774 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8775
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008776 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008777 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8778 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8779 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8780 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8781 only.
8782
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008783 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008784 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8785 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8786 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8787 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8788
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008789 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008790 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8791 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008792 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008793 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8794 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8795 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8796 the respective protocols.
8797 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008798 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008799
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008800 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008801
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008802 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8803 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8804 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8805 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008806
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008807 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8808 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8809 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008810
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008811
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008812 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008813 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008814 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008815 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008816
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008817 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008818 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008819 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008820
8821 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8822 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008823 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008824 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008825 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008826 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008827 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008828 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008829 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8830 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008831 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008832 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8833 tcp-check expect string +OK
8834
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008835 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008836 (send many headers before analyzing)
8837 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008838 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008839 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8840 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8841 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8842 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008843 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008844
8845
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008846 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008847
8848
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008849option tcp-smart-accept
8850no option tcp-smart-accept
8851 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8853 yes | yes | yes | no
8854 Arguments : none
8855
8856 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8857 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8858 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8859 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8860 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8861 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8862
8863 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8864 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8865 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8866 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8867
8868 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8869 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8870 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008871 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008872
8873 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8874 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8875 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8876
8877 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8878 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8879 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8880
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008881 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8882
8883
8884option tcp-smart-connect
8885no option tcp-smart-connect
8886 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8888 yes | no | yes | yes
8889 Arguments : none
8890
8891 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8892 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8893 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8894 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8895 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8896
8897 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8898 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8899 complex.
8900
8901 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8902 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8903 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8904
8905 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8906 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8907
8908 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8909
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008910
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008911option tcpka
8912 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8914 yes | yes | yes | yes
8915 Arguments : none
8916
8917 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8918 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008919 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008920 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8921
8922 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8923 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8924 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8925 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8926
8927 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8928 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8929 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8930 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8931 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8932
8933 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8934
8935 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8936 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8937 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8938 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8939 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8940 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8941 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8942 backends.
8943
8944 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8945
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008946
8947option tcplog
8948 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008950 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008951 Arguments : none
8952
8953 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8954 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8955 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8956 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8957 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8958 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8959 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8960 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8961
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008962 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008964 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008965
8966
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008967option transparent
8968no option transparent
8969 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008971 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008972 Arguments : none
8973
8974 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8975 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8976 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8977 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8978 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8979 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8980 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8981 appropriate server.
8982
8983 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8984 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8985
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008986 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008987 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008988
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008989
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008990external-check command <command>
8991 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8993 yes | no | yes | yes
8994
8995 Arguments :
8996 <command> is the external command to run
8997
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008998 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8999
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009000 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009001
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009002 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9003 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9004 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9005 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9006 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9007 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009008
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009009 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9010
9011 Environment variables :
9012 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9013 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9014
9015 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9016
9017 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9018
9019 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9020 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9021 for a UNIX socket).
9022
9023 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9024
9025 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9026
9027 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9028
9029 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9030
9031 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9032
9033 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9034 socket).
9035
9036 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9037 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9038
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009039 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9040
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009041 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9042 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9043 failed.
9044
9045 Example :
9046 external-check command /bin/true
9047
9048 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9049
9050
9051external-check path <path>
9052 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9054 yes | no | yes | yes
9055
9056 Arguments :
9057 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9058
9059 The default path is "".
9060
9061 Example :
9062 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9063
9064 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9065 "external-check command"
9066
9067
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009068persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009069persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009070 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9072 yes | no | yes | yes
9073 Arguments :
9074 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009075 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9076 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009077
9078 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9079 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009080 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009081 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9082 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9083 forwarded to this server.
9084
9085 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9086 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9087 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009088 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009089 a single "listen" section.
9090
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009091 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9092 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9093 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9094
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009095 Example :
9096 listen tse-farm
9097 bind :3389
9098 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9099 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9100 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9101 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9102 persist rdp-cookie
9103 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009104 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009105 balance rdp-cookie
9106 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9107 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9108
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009109 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9110 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009111
9112
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009113rate-limit sessions <rate>
9114 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9116 yes | yes | yes | no
9117 Arguments :
9118 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9119 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9120
9121 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9122 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9123 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9124 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9125 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9126 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9127
9128 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9129 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9130 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9131 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9132
9133 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9134 listen smtp
9135 mode tcp
9136 bind :25
9137 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009138 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009139
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009140 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9141 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9142 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009143
9144 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9145
9146
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009147redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9148redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9149redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009150 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9152 no | yes | yes | yes
9153
9154 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009155 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009156
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009157 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009158 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009159 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9160 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9161 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009162
9163 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9164 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9165 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9166 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9167 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009168 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9169 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9170 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9171 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009172
9173 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9174 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9175 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9176 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9177 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9178 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009179 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009180 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009181 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9182 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9183 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009184
9185 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009186 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9187 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9188 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009189 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009190 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9191 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9192 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9193 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009194
9195 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009196 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009197
9198 - "drop-query"
9199 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9200 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9201 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9202 with a location-type redirect.
9203
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009204 - "append-slash"
9205 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9206 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9207 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9208 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9209
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009210 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9211 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9212 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9213 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9214 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9215 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9216 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9217
9218 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9219 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9220 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9221 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9222 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9223 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9224 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009225
9226 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9227 acl clear dst_port 80
9228 acl secure dst_port 8080
9229 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009230 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009231 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009232 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9233
9234 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009235 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9236 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9237 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009238 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009239
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009240 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9241 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9242 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9243
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009244 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009245 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009246
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009247 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009248 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9249 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9250 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009252 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009253
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009254
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009255retries <value>
9256 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9257 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9258 yes | no | yes | yes
9259 Arguments :
9260 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9261 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9262 default value is 3.
9263
9264 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9265 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9266 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9267
9268 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009269 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9270 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009271
9272 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9273 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9274
9275 See also : "option redispatch"
9276
9277
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009278retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009279 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9280 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9281 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9283 yes | no | yes | yes
9284 Arguments :
9285 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9286 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9287 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9288 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9289
9290 none never retry
9291
9292 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9293 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9294
9295 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9296 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9297 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9298 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9299 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9300 processing the request.
9301
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009302 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9303 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9304 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9305 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9306 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9307 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9308 overflow attack for example).
9309
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009310 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9311 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9312 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9313 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9314 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9315 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9316 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9317 amplify denial of service attacks.
9318
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009319 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9320 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9321 considered to be safe to retry.
9322
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009323 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9324 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9325 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9326 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9327
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009328 all-retryable-errors
9329 retry request for any error that are considered
9330 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9331 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9332 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9333
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009334 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9335 not cumulative.
9336
9337 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9338 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9339 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9340 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9341
9342 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9343 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9344 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9345 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9346 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9347 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9348 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9349 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9350 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9351 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9352 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9353 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9354
9355 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9356 should not use this directive.
9357
9358 The default is "conn-failure".
9359
9360 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9361
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009362server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009363 Declare a server in a backend
9364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9365 no | no | yes | yes
9366 Arguments :
9367 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009368 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009369 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009370
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009371 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9372 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9373 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9374 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009375 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9376 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9377 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9378 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9379 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009380 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9381 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9382 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9383 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9384 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9385 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9386 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009387 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009388 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9389 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9390 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9391 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9392 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9393 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009394 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9395 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009396 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9397 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009398
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009399 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009400 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9401 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9402 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9403 adding this value to the client's port.
9404
9405 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9406 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009407 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009408
9409 Examples :
9410 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9411 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009412 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009413 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9414 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9415 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009416
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009417 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9418 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9419 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9420 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9421 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9422
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009423 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9424 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009425
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009426server-state-file-name [<file>]
9427 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9428 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9429 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9430 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9431 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9432 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9433
9434 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9435 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9436
9437 global
9438 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9439
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009440 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009441 load-server-state-from-file
9442
9443 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9444 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009445
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009446server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9447 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9448 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9450 no | no | yes | yes
9451
9452 Arguments:
9453 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9454
9455 <num | range>
9456 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9457 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9458 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9459 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9460
9461 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9462
9463 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9464
9465 <params*>
9466 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9467 keyword.
9468
9469 Examples:
9470 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9471 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9472 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9473
9474 # or
9475 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9476
9477 # would be equivalent to:
9478 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9479 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9480 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9481
9482
9483
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009484source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009485source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009486source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009487 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9489 yes | no | yes | yes
9490 Arguments :
9491 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9492 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009493
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009494 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009495 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9496 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9497 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9498 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9499 supported prefixes are :
9500 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9501 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9502 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009503 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009504 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9505 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009506
9507 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9508 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009509 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9510 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9511 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009512
9513 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9514 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9515 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9516 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9517 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9518 <addr>.
9519
9520 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9521 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9522 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9523 port.
9524
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009525 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9526 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9527 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9528 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009529 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009530 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9531 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9532 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9533 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9534 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9535 HTTP header.
9536
9537 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9538 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009539 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009540 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9541 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9542 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9543 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9544 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9545 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9546 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9547
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009548 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9549 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9550 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9551 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9552 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9553 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9554
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009555 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9556 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9557 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9558 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9559
9560 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9561 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9562 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9563 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9564 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9565 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9566
9567 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9568 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9569 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9570 there are two methods :
9571
9572 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9573 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9574 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9575 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9576 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9577 of the client ranges may be used.
9578
9579 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9580 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9581 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9582 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9583 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9584 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9585 same session.
9586
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009587 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9588 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9589 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009590 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009591
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009592 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9593
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009594 Examples :
9595 backend private
9596 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9597 source 192.168.1.200
9598
9599 backend transparent_ssl1
9600 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9601 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9602
9603 backend transparent_ssl2
9604 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9605 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9606 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9607
9608 backend transparent_ssl3
9609 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9610 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9611 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9612
9613 backend transparent_smtp
9614 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9615 # with Tproxy version 4.
9616 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9617
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009618 backend transparent_http
9619 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9620 # proxy.
9621 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009623 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009624 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9625
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009626
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009627srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9628 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9629 the connection on the server side.
9630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9631 yes | no | yes | yes
9632 Arguments :
9633 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9634
9635 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9636 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009637 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9638 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009639
9640 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9641
9642
9643srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9644 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9645 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9646 server side.
9647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9648 yes | no | yes | yes
9649 Arguments :
9650 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9651 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9652 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9653 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9654
9655 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9656 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009657 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9658 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009659
9660 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9661
9662
9663srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9664 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9666 yes | no | yes | yes
9667 Arguments :
9668 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9669 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9670 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9671 document.
9672
9673 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9674 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009675 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9676 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009677
9678 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9679
9680
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009681stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9682 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009684 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009685
9686 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9687 matched.
9688
9689 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9690 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9691
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009692 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9693 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009694 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009695
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009696 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9697 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9698 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9699 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009700
9701 Example :
9702 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9703 backend stats_localhost
9704 stats enable
9705 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9706
9707 Example :
9708 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9709 backend stats_auth
9710 stats enable
9711 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9712 stats admin if TRUE
9713
9714 Example :
9715 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9716 userlist stats-auth
9717 group admin users admin
9718 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9719 group readonly users haproxy
9720 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9721
9722 backend stats_auth
9723 stats enable
9724 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9725 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9726 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9727 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9728
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009729 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9730 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9731 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009732
9733
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009734stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9735 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009737 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009738 Arguments :
9739 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9740
9741 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9742
9743 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9744 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9745 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9746 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9747 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9748 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9749
9750 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9751 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9752 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009753 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009754
9755 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9756 report using "stats scope".
9757
9758 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9759 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9760 unobvious parameters.
9761
9762 Example :
9763 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9764 backend public_www
9765 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9766 stats enable
9767 stats hide-version
9768 stats scope .
9769 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009770 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009771 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9772 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9773
9774 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9775 backend private_monitoring
9776 stats enable
9777 stats uri /admin?stats
9778 stats refresh 5s
9779
9780 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9781
9782
9783stats enable
9784 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009786 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009787 Arguments : none
9788
9789 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9790 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9791 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9792 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9793 - stats auth : no authentication
9794 - stats scope : no restriction
9795
9796 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9797 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9798 unobvious parameters.
9799
9800 Example :
9801 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9802 backend public_www
9803 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9804 stats enable
9805 stats hide-version
9806 stats scope .
9807 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009808 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009809 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9810 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9811
9812 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9813 backend private_monitoring
9814 stats enable
9815 stats uri /admin?stats
9816 stats refresh 5s
9817
9818 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9819
9820
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009821stats hide-version
9822 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009824 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009825 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009826
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009827 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9828 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9829 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9830 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9831 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9832 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009834 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9835 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9836 unobvious parameters.
9837
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009838 Example :
9839 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9840 backend public_www
9841 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009842 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009843 stats hide-version
9844 stats scope .
9845 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009846 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009847 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9848 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009849
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009850 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9851 backend private_monitoring
9852 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009853 stats uri /admin?stats
9854 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009855
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009856 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009857
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009858
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009859stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9860 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9861 Access control for statistics
9862
9863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9864 no | no | yes | yes
9865
9866 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9867 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9868 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9869 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9870 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9871 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9872
9873 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9874 instance.
9875
9876 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9877 about ACL usage.
9878
9879
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009880stats realm <realm>
9881 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009883 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009884 Arguments :
9885 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9886 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9887 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9888
9889 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9890 using a backslash ('\').
9891
9892 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9893 only related to authentication.
9894
9895 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9896 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9897 unobvious parameters.
9898
9899 Example :
9900 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9901 backend public_www
9902 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9903 stats enable
9904 stats hide-version
9905 stats scope .
9906 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009907 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009908 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9909 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9910
9911 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9912 backend private_monitoring
9913 stats enable
9914 stats uri /admin?stats
9915 stats refresh 5s
9916
9917 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9918
9919
9920stats refresh <delay>
9921 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009923 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009924 Arguments :
9925 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9926 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9927 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9928 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9929 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9930 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9931
9932 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9933 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9934 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -05009935 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009936
9937 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9938 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9939 unobvious parameters.
9940
9941 Example :
9942 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9943 backend public_www
9944 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9945 stats enable
9946 stats hide-version
9947 stats scope .
9948 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009949 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009950 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9951 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9952
9953 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9954 backend private_monitoring
9955 stats enable
9956 stats uri /admin?stats
9957 stats refresh 5s
9958
9959 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9960
9961
9962stats scope { <name> | "." }
9963 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009965 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009966 Arguments :
9967 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9968 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9969 section in which the statement appears.
9970
9971 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9972 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9973 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9974 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9975 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9976 exists.
9977
9978 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9979 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9980 unobvious parameters.
9981
9982 Example :
9983 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9984 backend public_www
9985 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9986 stats enable
9987 stats hide-version
9988 stats scope .
9989 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009990 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009991 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9992 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9993
9994 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9995 backend private_monitoring
9996 stats enable
9997 stats uri /admin?stats
9998 stats refresh 5s
9999
10000 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10001
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010002
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010003stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010004 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010006 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010007
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010008 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010009 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10010
10011 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10012 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10013
10014 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10015 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010016 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010017
10018 Example :
10019 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10020 backend private_monitoring
10021 stats enable
10022 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10023 stats uri /admin?stats
10024 stats refresh 5s
10025
10026 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10027 global section.
10028
10029
10030stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010031 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10033 yes | yes | yes | yes
10034 Arguments : none
10035
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010036 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010037 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10038 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10039 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10040 - IP (socket, server)
10041 - cookie (backend, server)
10042
10043 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10044 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010045 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010046
10047 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10048
10049
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010050stats show-modules
10051 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10053 yes | yes | yes | yes
10054 Arguments : none
10055
10056 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10057 values as a tooltip.
10058
10059 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10060 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10061 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10062
10063 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10064
10065
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010066stats show-node [ <name> ]
10067 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010069 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010070 Arguments:
10071 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10072 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10073
10074 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10075 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010076 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010077
10078 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10079 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10080 unobvious parameters.
10081
10082 Example:
10083 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10084 backend private_monitoring
10085 stats enable
10086 stats show-node Europe-1
10087 stats uri /admin?stats
10088 stats refresh 5s
10089
10090 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10091 section.
10092
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010093
10094stats uri <prefix>
10095 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010097 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010098 Arguments :
10099 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10100 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10101 query string.
10102
10103 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10104 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10105 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10106 possible to reach it in the application.
10107
10108 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010109 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010110 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10111 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10112 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10113 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10114
10115 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10116 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10117 an address or a port to statistics only.
10118
10119 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10120 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10121 unobvious parameters.
10122
10123 Example :
10124 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10125 backend public_www
10126 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10127 stats enable
10128 stats hide-version
10129 stats scope .
10130 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010131 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010132 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10133 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10134
10135 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10136 backend private_monitoring
10137 stats enable
10138 stats uri /admin?stats
10139 stats refresh 5s
10140
10141 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10142
10143
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010144stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10145 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010147 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010148
10149 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010150 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010151 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010152 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010153 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10154
10155 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10156 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10157 the "stick-table" statement.
10158
10159 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10160 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10161 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10162 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10163 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10164
10165 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10166 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10167 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10168 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10169 transformation rules.
10170
10171 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10172 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10173 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10174 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10175 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10176 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10177 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10178
10179 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10180 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10181 ACL based conditions.
10182
10183 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10184 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10185 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10186 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10187
10188 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10189 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10190 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10191 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10192
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010193 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10194 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010195 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010196
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010197 Example :
10198 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10199 # last 30 minutes
10200 backend pop
10201 mode tcp
10202 balance roundrobin
10203 stick store-request src
10204 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10205 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10206 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10207
10208 backend smtp
10209 mode tcp
10210 balance roundrobin
10211 stick match src table pop
10212 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10213 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10214
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010215 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010216 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010217
10218
10219stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10220 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10222 no | no | yes | yes
10223
10224 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10225 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10226 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10227 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10228
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010229 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10230 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010231 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010232
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010233 Examples :
10234 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010235 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010236
10237 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10238 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10239 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10240
10241
10242 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10243 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10244 backend http
10245 mode http
10246 balance roundrobin
10247 stick on src table https
10248 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10249 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10250 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10251
10252 backend https
10253 mode tcp
10254 balance roundrobin
10255 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10256 stick on src
10257 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10258 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10259
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010260 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010261
10262
10263stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10264 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10266 no | no | yes | yes
10267
10268 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010269 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010270 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010271 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010272 server is selected.
10273
10274 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10275 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10276 the "stick-table" statement.
10277
10278 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10279 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10280 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10281 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10282 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10283 address.
10284
10285 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10286 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10287 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10288 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10289 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10290 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10291 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10292 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10293 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10294 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10295
10296 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10297 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10298 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10299 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10300 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10301 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10302 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10303
10304 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10305 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10306 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10307 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10308
10309 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10310 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10311 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10312 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10313 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10314 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010315 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10316 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10317 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10318 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10319 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10320 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010321
10322 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10323 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10324 the request.
10325
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010326 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10327 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010328 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010329
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010330 Example :
10331 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10332 # last 30 minutes
10333 backend pop
10334 mode tcp
10335 balance roundrobin
10336 stick store-request src
10337 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10338 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10339 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10340
10341 backend smtp
10342 mode tcp
10343 balance roundrobin
10344 stick match src table pop
10345 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10346 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10347
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010348 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010349 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010350
10351
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010352stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010353 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10354 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010355 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010357 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010358
10359 Arguments :
10360 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10361 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10362 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10363 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10364
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010365 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10366 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10367 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10368 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10369
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010370 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10371 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10372 instance.
10373
10374 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10375 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10376 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10377 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10378 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10379 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010380 to 32 characters.
10381
10382 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10383 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10384 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010385 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010386 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10387 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010388
10389 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010390 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10391 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010392 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10393 increase.
10394
10395 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010396 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10397 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10398 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010399
10400 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10401 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10402 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10403 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010404 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010405 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10406 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10407 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10408 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10409 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10410 parameter (see below).
10411
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010412 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10413 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10414 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10415 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10416 soft restart.
10417
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010418 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10419 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010420
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010421 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10422 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10423 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10424 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010425 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010426 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010427 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10428 if not expiration delay is specified.
10429
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010430 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10431 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10432 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10433 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010434 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10435 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10436 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10437 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10438 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10439 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10440 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10441 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10442 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10443 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10444 types and their arguments.
10445
10446 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10447 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10448 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10449 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10450
10451 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10452 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10453 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010454 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010455
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010456 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10457 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10458 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010459 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010460 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010461 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010462
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010463 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10464 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10465 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10466 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10467
10468 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10469 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10470 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10471 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10472 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10473 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10474
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010475 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10476 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10477 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10478 they were received.
10479
10480 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10481 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10482 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10483 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10484 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10485
10486 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10487 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10488 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10489 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10490 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10491
10492 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10493 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10494 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10495
10496 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10497 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10498 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10499 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10500 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10501
10502 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10503 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10504 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10505 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10506 the client side.
10507
10508 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10509 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10510 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10511 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10512 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10513 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10514 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10515
10516 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10517 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10518 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10519 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10520 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10521 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010522 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010523
10524 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10525 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10526 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10527 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10528 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10529 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10530
10531 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010532 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010533 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10534 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10535
10536 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10537 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10538 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10539 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10540 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10541 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10542 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10543 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10544 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10545 recommended for better fairness.
10546
10547 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010548 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010549 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10550 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10551
10552 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10553 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10554 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10555 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10556 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10557 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10558 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10559 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10560 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10561 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010562
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010563 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10564 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010565 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10566 reference it.
10567
10568 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10569 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010570 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10571 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10572 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010573
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010574 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10575 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10576 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10577 something that can be ignored.
10578
10579 Example:
10580 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10581 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10582 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10583 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10584
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010585 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010586 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010587
10588
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010589stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010590 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10592 no | no | yes | yes
10593
10594 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010595 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010596 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010597 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010598 server is selected.
10599
10600 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10601 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10602 the "stick-table" statement.
10603
10604 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10605 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10606 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10607 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10608
10609 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10610 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10611 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10612 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10613 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10614 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010615 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010616 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10617 rules.
10618
10619 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10620 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10621 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10622 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10623 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10624 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10625 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10626
10627 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10628 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10629 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10630 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10631
10632 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10633 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10634 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10635 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10636 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10637 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010638 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10639 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10640 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10641 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10642 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10643 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10644 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10645 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10646 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010647
10648 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10649
10650 Example :
10651 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10652 backend https
10653 mode tcp
10654 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010655 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010656 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010657
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010658 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10659 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10660
10661 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10662 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10663 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10664
10665 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10666 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010667
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010668 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10669 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10670 # at offset 44.
10671
10672 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10673 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10674
10675 # Learn on response if server hello.
10676 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010677
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010678 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10679 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10680
10681 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10682 extraction.
10683
10684
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010685tcp-check comment <string>
10686 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10687 it fails.
10688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10689 yes | no | yes | yes
10690
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010691 Arguments :
10692 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10693 rule fails.
10694
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010695 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10696 user-friendly error reporting.
10697
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010698 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10699 "tcp-check expect".
10700
10701
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010702tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10703 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010704 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010705 Opens a new connection
10706 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010707 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010708
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010709 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010710 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10711
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010712 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010713 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010714
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010715 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010716 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10717 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010718 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010719
10720 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010721
10722 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10723
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010724 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10725
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010726 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10727
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010728 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10729
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010730 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10731 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10732 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10733 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10734
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010735 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10736 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10737 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10738 haproxy -vv.
10739
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010740 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010741
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010742 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10743 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10744 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10745
10746 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10747 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10748 of the sequence.
10749
10750 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10751 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10752 do.
10753
10754 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10755 unset-var or comment rules.
10756
10757 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010758 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10759 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10760 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10761 option tcp-check
10762 tcp-check connect
10763 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10764 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10765 tcp-check send \r\n
10766 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10767 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10768 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10769 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10770 tcp-check send \r\n
10771 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10772 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10773
10774 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10775 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010776 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010777 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10778 tcp-check connect port 143
10779 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10780 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10781
10782 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10783
10784
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010785tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010786 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010787 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010788 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010789 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010790 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010791 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010792
10793 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010794 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10795
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010796 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10797 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10798 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10799 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10800 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10801 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10802 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10803 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10804 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10805 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10806
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010807 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010808 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10809 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010810 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10811 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10812 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10813
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010814 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10815 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10816 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010817 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10818 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10819 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10820 example 404 with disable-on-404
10821 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10822 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010823 By default "L7OK" is used.
10824
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010825 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10826 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010827 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10828 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10829 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10830 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10831 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10832 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010833
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010834 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010835 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010836 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10837 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10838 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10839 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010840 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10841
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010842 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10843 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10844 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10845 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10846
10847 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10848 informational message reported in logs if an error
10849 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10850 log-format string.
10851
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010852 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10853 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10854 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10855 followed by some converters.
10856
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010857 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10858 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10859 with the usual backslash ('\').
10860 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010861 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010862 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10863 used upper or lower case.
10864
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010865 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10866
10867 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10868 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10869 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10870 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10871 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10872 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10873 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10874 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10875
10876 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10877 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10878 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10879 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10880 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10881 expression.
10882
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010883 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10884 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10885 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10886 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10887 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10888 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10889
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010890 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10891 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10892 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10893 this exact hexadecimal string.
10894 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10895
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010896 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10897 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10898 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10899 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10900 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10901 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10902 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10903 size.
10904
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010905 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10906 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10907 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10908 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10909 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10910 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10911 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10912 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10913 in a binary string before matching the response's
10914 buffer.
10915
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010916 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10917 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10918 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10919 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10920 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10921 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10922 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10923 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10924 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10925 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10926 the null character.
10927
10928 Examples :
10929 # perform a POP check
10930 option tcp-check
10931 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10932
10933 # perform an IMAP check
10934 option tcp-check
10935 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10936
10937 # look for the redis master server
10938 option tcp-check
10939 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010940 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010941 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10942 tcp-check expect string role:master
10943 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10944 tcp-check expect string +OK
10945
10946
10947 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10948 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10949
10950
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010951tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10952tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10953 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10954 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010955 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010956 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010957
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010958 Arguments :
10959 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10960
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010961 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10962 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010963
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010964 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10965 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010966
10967 Examples :
10968 # look for the redis master server
10969 option tcp-check
10970 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10971 tcp-check expect string role:master
10972
10973 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10974 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10975
10976
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010977tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10978tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10979 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10980 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010982 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010983
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010984 Arguments :
10985 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010986
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010987 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10988 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010989
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010990 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10991 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10992 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010993
10994 Examples :
10995 # redis check in binary
10996 option tcp-check
10997 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10998 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10999
11000
11001 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
11002 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
11003
11004
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011005tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011006 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011008 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011009
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011010 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011011 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11012 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11013 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11014 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11015 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11016 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11017 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11018 and '-'.
11019
11020 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11021
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011022 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011023 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11024
11025
11026tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011027 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011029 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011030
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011031 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011032 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11033 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11034 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11035 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11036 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11037 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11038 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11039 and '-'.
11040
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011041 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011042 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11043
11044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011045tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11046 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11048 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011049 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011050 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11051 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011053 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011054
11055 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11056 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011057 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11058 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11059 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11060 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11061 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11062 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011064 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11065 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11066 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11067 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011068
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011069 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011070 - accept :
11071 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11072 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11073 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011074
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011075 - reject :
11076 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11077 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11078 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11079 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11080 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11081 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11082 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11083 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11084 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11085 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11086 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011087 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011088
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011089 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11090 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11091 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11092 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11093 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11094 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11095 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11096 hosts.
11097
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011098 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11099 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11100 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11101 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11102 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11103 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11104 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11105 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11106
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011107 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11108 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11109 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11110 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11111 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11112 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11113 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11114 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11115 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011116 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11117 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011118
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011119 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011120 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011121 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11122 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11123 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011124 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011125 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011126 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11127 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11128 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11129 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11130 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11131 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11132 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011133
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011134 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011135 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011136 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011137 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011138 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11139 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11140 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011141
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011142 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11143 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11144 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11145 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011146
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011147 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11148 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11149 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11150 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11151 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011152 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11153 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11154 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11155 layer7 information is extracted.
11156
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011157 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11158 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11159 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11160 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11161 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011162
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011163 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11164 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11165 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11166 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11167
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011168 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11169 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11170 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11171 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11172
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011173 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11174 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11175 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11176 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11177 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011178
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011179 - set-src <expr> :
11180 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11181 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11182 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011183 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011185 Arguments:
11186 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11187 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011188
11189 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011190 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11191
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011192 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11193 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011194
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011195 - set-src-port <expr> :
11196 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11197 expression.
11198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011199 Arguments:
11200 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11201 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011202
11203 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011204 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11205
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011206 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11207 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11208 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011209
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011210 - set-dst <expr> :
11211 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11212 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11213 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11214 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11215 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11216
11217 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11218 followed by some converters.
11219
11220 Example:
11221
11222 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11223 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11224
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011225 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11226 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11227
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011228 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11229 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11230 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11231 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11232
11233
11234 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11235 followed by some converters.
11236
11237 Example:
11238
11239 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11240
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011241 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11242 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11243 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11244
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011245 - "silent-drop" :
11246 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011247 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011248 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11249 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11250 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11251 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11252 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011253 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11254 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011255 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11256 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011257 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011258 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11259 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11260 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11261 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011263 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11264 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11265 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011266
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011267 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11268 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11269 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011270
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011271 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011272 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011273 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011275 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11276 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11277 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011279 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011280 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11281 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011282
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011283 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11284
11285 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11286
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011287 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11288
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011289 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011290
11291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011292tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11293 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011295 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011296 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011297 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11298 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011299
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011300 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011301
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011302 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011303 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11304 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11305 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11306 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011307
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011308 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11309 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11310 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11311 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011312 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11313 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11314 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11315 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11316 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11317 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011318 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011319 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011320
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011321 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11322 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11323 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11324 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011325
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011326 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011327 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011328 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011329 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11330 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011331 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011332 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011333 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011334 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011335 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011336 - set-dst <expr>
11337 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011338 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011339 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011340 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011341 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011342 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011343
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011344 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11345 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011346 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11347 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011348
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011349 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11350 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11351 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11352 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11353 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11354 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011355
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011356 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011357 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11358 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011359
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011360 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11361 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11362 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11363 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11364 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11365 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11366
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011367 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011368 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11369 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11370 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11371 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11372 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11373 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11374 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11375 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11376 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11377 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011378
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011379 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011380 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11381 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11382 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011383
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011384 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11385 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11386
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011387 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011388 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11389 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011390
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011391 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11392 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011393 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011394 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11395 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011396 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011397 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011398 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011399 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11400 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011401 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011402 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11403 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011404
11405 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11406 followed by some converters.
11407
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011408 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11409 <var-name>.
11410
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011411 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11412 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11413 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11414 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11415 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11416
11417 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11418 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11419 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11420 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11421 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11422 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11423 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11424 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11425 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11426 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11427 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11428
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011429 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11430 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11431 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11432 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11433 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11434
11435 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11436
11437 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11438
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011439 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11440 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11441 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11442 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11443 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11444 evaluated.
11445
11446 Example:
11447 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11448
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011449 Example:
11450
11451 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011452 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011453
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011454 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011455 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11456 # and reject everything else.
11457 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11458 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011459 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011460 tcp-request content reject
11461
11462 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011463 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11464 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11465 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011466 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011467
11468 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11469 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11470 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011471 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011472 tcp-request content reject
11473
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011474 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011475 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011476 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011477 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011478 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11479 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011480
11481 Example:
11482 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11483 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011484 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011485
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011486 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011487 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011488
11489 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011490 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011491 # protecting all our sites
11492 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011493 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11494 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011495 ...
11496 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11497
11498 backend http_dynamic
11499 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011500 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011501 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011502 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011503 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011504 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011505 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011507 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011508
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011509 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11510 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011511
11512
11513tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11514 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011516 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011517 Arguments :
11518 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11519 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11520 as explained at the top of this document.
11521
11522 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11523 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11524 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11525 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11526 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11527
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011528 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11529 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11530 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11531 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11532
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011533 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11534 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011535 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011536 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011537 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11538 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11539 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11540 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011541
11542 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11543 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11544 it pass through unaffected.
11545
11546 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11547 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11548 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011549 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011550 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11551 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011552 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11553 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11554 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011555
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011556 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011557 "timeout client".
11558
11559
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011560tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11561 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11563 no | no | yes | yes
11564 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011565 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11566 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011567
11568 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11569
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011570 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011571 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11572 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011573 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11574 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011575
11576 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11577
11578 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11579 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11580 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11581 inserted.
11582
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011583 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011584 - accept :
11585 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11586 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11587 the rules evaluation.
11588
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011589 - close :
11590 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11591 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11592 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11593 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11594 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11595 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011596 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011597 protocols.
11598
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011599 - reject :
11600 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11601 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011602 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011603
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011604 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11605 Sets a variable.
11606
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011607 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11608 Unsets a variable.
11609
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011610 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11611 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11612 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11613 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11614
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011615 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11616 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11617 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11618 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11619
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011620 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11621 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11622 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11623 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11624 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011625
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011626 - "silent-drop" :
11627 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011628 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011629 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11630 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11631 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11632 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11633 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011634 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11635 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011636 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11637 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011638 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011639 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11640 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11641 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11642 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11643
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011644 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11645 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11646
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011647 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11648 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11649 for changing the default action to a reject.
11650
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011651 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11652 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11653 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11654 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011655 period.
11656
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011657 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11658 declared inline.
11659
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011660 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11661 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011662 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011663 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11664 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011665 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011666 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011667 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011668 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11669 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011670 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011671 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11672 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011673
11674 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11675 followed by some converters.
11676
11677 Example:
11678
11679 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11680
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011681 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11682 <var-name>.
11683
11684 Example:
11685
11686 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11687
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011688 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11689 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11690 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11691 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11692 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11693
11694 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11695
11696 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11697
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011698 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11699
11700 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11701
11702
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011703tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11704 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11706 no | yes | yes | no
11707 Arguments :
11708 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11709 below.
11710
11711 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11712
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011713 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011714 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11715 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11716 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11717 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11718 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11719 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11720 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011721 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011722 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11723 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11724 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11725 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11726 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11727 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11728 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11729 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11730 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11731 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11732 instead.
11733
11734 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11735 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11736 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11737 rules which may be inserted.
11738
11739 Several types of actions are supported :
11740 - accept : the request is accepted
11741 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11742 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11743 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011744 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011745 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011746 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011747 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011748 - silent-drop
11749
11750 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11751 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11752 sections for a complete description.
11753
11754 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11755 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11756 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11757
11758 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11759 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11760 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11761 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11762 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11763
11764 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11765 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11766
11767 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11768 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11769 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11770
11771 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11772 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11773 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11774
11775 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11776 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11777 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11778
11779 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11780 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11781 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11782
11783 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11784
11785 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11786
11787
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011788tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11789 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11791 no | no | yes | yes
11792 Arguments :
11793 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11794 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11795 as explained at the top of this document.
11796
11797 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11798
11799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011800timeout check <timeout>
11801 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11802 established.
11803
11804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11805 yes | no | yes | yes
11806 Arguments:
11807 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11808 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11809 as explained at the top of this document.
11810
11811 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11812 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011813 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011814 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011815 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11816 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11817 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011818
11819 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11820 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11821
11822 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11823 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011824 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011825
11826 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11827 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11828 forget about it.
11829
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011830 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11831 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011832
11833
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011834timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011835 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11837 yes | yes | yes | no
11838 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011839 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011840 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11841 as explained at the top of this document.
11842
11843 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11844 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11845 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011846 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11847 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11848 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11849 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011850 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11851 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11852 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011853 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011854 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011855 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11856 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011857 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11858 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011859
11860 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11861 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11862 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11863 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011864 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011865 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11866
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011867 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011868
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011869 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011870
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011871
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011872timeout client-fin <timeout>
11873 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11875 yes | yes | yes | no
11876 Arguments :
11877 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11878 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11879 as explained at the top of this document.
11880
11881 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11882 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11883 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11884 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11885 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11886 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11887 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011888 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11889 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11890 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011891
11892 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11893 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11894 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11895
11896 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11897
11898
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011899timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011900 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11902 yes | no | yes | yes
11903 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011904 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011905 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11906 as explained at the top of this document.
11907
11908 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011909 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011910 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011911 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011912 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11913 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011914
11915 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11916 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11917 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11918 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011919 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011920 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11921
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011922 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011923
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011924
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011925timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11926 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11928 yes | yes | yes | yes
11929 Arguments :
11930 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11931 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11932 as explained at the top of this document.
11933
11934 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11935 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11936 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11937 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11938 once the request has started to present itself.
11939
11940 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11941 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11942 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11943 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11944 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11945
11946 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11947 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11948 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11949 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11950
11951 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11952 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011953 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011954 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11955 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011956 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011957
11958 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11959 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11960 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11961 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11962
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011963 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11964 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011965 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11966
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011967 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11968
11969
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011970timeout http-request <timeout>
11971 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011973 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011974 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011975 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011976 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11977 as explained at the top of this document.
11978
11979 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11980 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11981 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11982 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11983 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11984 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11985 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011986 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11987 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11988 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11989 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011990 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011991 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11992 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011993
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011994 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11995 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11996 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11997 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11998 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011999 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012000
12001 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12002 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012003 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012004 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12005 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12006
12007 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012008 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12009 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12010 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012011
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012012 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012013 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012014
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012015
12016timeout queue <timeout>
12017 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12019 yes | no | yes | yes
12020 Arguments :
12021 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12022 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12023 as explained at the top of this document.
12024
12025 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12026 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12027 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12028 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12029 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12030
12031 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12032 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12033 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12034 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12035
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012036 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012037
12038
12039timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012040 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12042 yes | no | yes | yes
12043 Arguments :
12044 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12045 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12046 as explained at the top of this document.
12047
12048 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12049 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12050 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12051 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12052 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12053 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12054 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12055
12056 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12057 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12058 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12059 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12060 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012061 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012062 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012063 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12064 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012065 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12066 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012067
12068 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12069 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12070 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12071 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012072 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012073 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12074
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012075 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012076
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012077
12078timeout server-fin <timeout>
12079 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12081 yes | no | yes | yes
12082 Arguments :
12083 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12084 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12085 as explained at the top of this document.
12086
12087 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12088 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12089 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12090 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12091 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12092 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12093 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12094 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12095 situations, it should not be needed.
12096
12097 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12098 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12099 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12100
12101 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12102
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012103
12104timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012105 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12107 yes | yes | yes | yes
12108 Arguments :
12109 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12110 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12111 as explained at the top of this document.
12112
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012113 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12114 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12115 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012116
12117 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12118 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12119 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12120 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012121 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012122
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012123 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012124
12125
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012126timeout tunnel <timeout>
12127 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12129 yes | no | yes | yes
12130 Arguments :
12131 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12132 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12133 as explained at the top of this document.
12134
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012135 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012136 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12137 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12138 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012139 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12140 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012141 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12142 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12143 specified.
12144
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012145 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12146 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12147 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12148 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12149 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12150 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12151 state.
12152
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012153 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12154 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12155 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12156 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012157 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012158
12159 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12160 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12161 forget about it.
12162
12163 Example :
12164 defaults http
12165 option http-server-close
12166 timeout connect 5s
12167 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012168 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012169 timeout server 30s
12170 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12171
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012172 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012173
12174
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012175transparent (deprecated)
12176 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012178 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012179 Arguments : none
12180
12181 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12182 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12183 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12184 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12185 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12186 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12187 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12188 appropriate server.
12189
12190 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12191
12192 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12193 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12194
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012195 See also: "option transparent"
12196
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012197unique-id-format <string>
12198 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12200 yes | yes | yes | no
12201 Arguments :
12202 <string> is a log-format string.
12203
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012204 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12205 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12206 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12207 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012208
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012209 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12210 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12211 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12212 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12213 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12214 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12215 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12216 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012217
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012218 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12219 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012220
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012221 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012222
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012223 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012224
12225 will generate:
12226
12227 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12228
12229 See also: "unique-id-header"
12230
12231unique-id-header <name>
12232 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12234 yes | yes | yes | no
12235 Arguments :
12236 <name> is the name of the header.
12237
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012238 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12239 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012240
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012241 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012242
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012243 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012244 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12245
12246 will generate:
12247
12248 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12249
12250 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012251
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012252use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012253 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12255 no | yes | yes | no
12256 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012257 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12258 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012259
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012260 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12261 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012262
12263 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12264 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12265 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012266 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012267 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012268 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12269 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012270
12271 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12272 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12273 assign the backend.
12274
12275 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12276 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12277 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12278 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12279 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12280 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12281
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012282 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012283 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012284 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12285 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12286 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12287
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012288 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12289 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12290 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12291 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12292 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12293 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12294 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12295 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12296 cannot be forced from the request.
12297
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012298 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012299 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12300 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12301
12302 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12303 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012304
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012305use-fcgi-app <name>
12306 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12308 no | no | yes | yes
12309 Arguments :
12310 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12311
12312 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012313
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012314use-server <server> if <condition>
12315use-server <server> unless <condition>
12316 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12318 no | no | yes | yes
12319 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012320 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12321 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012322
12323 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12324
12325 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12326 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12327 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12328
12329 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12330 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12331 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12332 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12333 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12334 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12335 matches will assign the server.
12336
12337 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12338 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12339 with the next rules until one matches.
12340
12341 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12342 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12343 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12344 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12345
12346 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12347 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12348 stripped.
12349
12350 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12351 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012352 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12353 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12354 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012355
12356 Example :
12357 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12358 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12359 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12360 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012361 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012362 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012363 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012364 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12365 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12366
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012367 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12368 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12369 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12370 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012371 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012372 and we fall back to load balancing.
12373
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012374 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012375
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012376
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100123775. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012378--------------------------
12379
12380The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12381depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12382settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12383written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12384described in this section.
12385
12386
123875.1. Bind options
12388-----------------
12389
12390The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12391as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12392no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12393parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12394while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12395provided immediately after the setting name.
12396
12397The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12398
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012399accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12400 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12401 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12402 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12403 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12404 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12405 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12406 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12407 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12408 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012409 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12410 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12411 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012412
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012413accept-proxy
12414 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012415 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12416 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012417 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12418 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12419 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12420 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012421 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012422 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12423 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012424 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12425 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012426
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012427allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012428 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012429 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012430 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012431 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12432 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012433
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012434alpn <protocols>
12435 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12436 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12437 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012438 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012439 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012440 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12441 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12442 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12443 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12444 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12445 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12446 preference, like below :
12447
12448 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012449
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012450backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012451 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012452 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12453
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012454curves <curves>
12455 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12456 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12457 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12458 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12459 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12460 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12461
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012462ecdhe <named curve>
12463 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012464 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12465 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012466
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012467ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012468 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12469 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12470 client's certificate.
12471
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012472ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12474 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12475 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12476 error is ignored.
12477
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012478ca-sign-file <cafile>
12479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12480 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12481 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12482 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12483 'generate-certificates' for details.
12484
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012485ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12487 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12488 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12489 'generate-certificates' for details.
12490
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012491ca-verify-file <cafile>
12492 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12493 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12494 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12495 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12496 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12497
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012498ciphers <ciphers>
12499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12500 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012501 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012502 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012503 information and recommendations see e.g.
12504 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12505 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12506 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12507
12508ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12509 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12510 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12511 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12512 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012513 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12514 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012515
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012516crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012517 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12518 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12519 to verify client's certificate.
12520
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012521crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012522 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12523 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12524 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12525 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12526 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012527 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12528 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012529
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012530 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12531 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12532
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012533 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12534 are loaded.
12535
12536 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012537 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12538 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12539 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12540 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12541 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12542 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12543 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012544 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012545
12546 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12547 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12548 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12549 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012550 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12551 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012552
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012553 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012554
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012555 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012556 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012557 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12558 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012559 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12560 clients).
12561
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012562 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12563 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12564 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12565 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12566 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12567 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12568 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12569 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12570 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12571 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12572 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12573 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12574 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12575
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012576 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12577 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12578 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12579 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12580 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12581
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012582 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12583 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12584 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12585 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012586
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012587 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12588 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12589 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012590
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012591crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012592 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012593 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012594 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012595 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012596
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012597crt-list <file>
12598 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012599 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12600 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012601
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012602 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12603
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012604 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12605 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12606 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12607 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12608 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012609
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012610 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012611 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12612 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12613 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12614 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12615 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012616 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12617 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12618 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012619
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012620 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12621 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12622 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012623
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012624 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12625
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012626 The first valid line declares the default certificate, which haproxy should
12627 use in the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches, just like the crt
12628 bind option. This certificate will also be used if the provided SNI matches
12629 its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI filter is declared later. The SNI filter
12630 !* can be used after the first certificate to not include its CN and SAN in
12631 the SNI tree, so it will never match except if no other certificate matches.
12632 This way the first declared certificate act as a fallback.
12633
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012634 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012635 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012636 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012637 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012638 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012639 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012640
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012641defer-accept
12642 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12643 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12644 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012645 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012646 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12647 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12648 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12649 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12650 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12651 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12652 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12653
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012654expose-fd listeners
12655 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12656 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012657 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12658 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012659 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012660
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012661force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012662 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012663 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012664 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012665 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012666
12667force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012668 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012669 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012670 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012671
12672force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012673 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012674 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012675 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012676
12677force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012678 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012679 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012680 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012681
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012682force-tlsv13
12683 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12684 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012685 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012686
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012687generate-certificates
12688 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12689 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12690 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12691 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12692 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12693 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12694 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12695 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12696 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12697 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12698 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12699
12700 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12701 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012702 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012703 certificate is used many times.
12704
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012705gid <gid>
12706 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12707 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12708 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12709 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12710 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12711
12712group <group>
12713 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12714 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12715 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12716 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12717 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12718
12719id <id>
12720 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12721 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12722 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12723 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12724
12725interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012726 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12727 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12728 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12729 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12730 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12731 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012732 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12733 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12734 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12735 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12736 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12737 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012738
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012739level <level>
12740 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12741 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12742 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012743 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012744 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12745 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12746 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012747 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012748 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012749 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012750 all counters).
12751
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012752severity-output <format>
12753 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12754 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12755 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12756 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12757 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12758 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12759 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12760 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12761 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12762 rfc5424 convention.
12763
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012764maxconn <maxconn>
12765 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12766 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12767 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12768 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12769 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12770 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12771 eat all memory.
12772
12773mode <mode>
12774 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12775 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12776 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12777 UNIX sockets.
12778
12779mss <maxseg>
12780 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12781 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12782 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12783 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12784 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12785 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12786 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12787 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12788 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12789 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12790 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12791
12792name <name>
12793 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12794 page.
12795
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012796namespace <name>
12797 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12798 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12799 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12800 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12801
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012802nice <nice>
12803 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12804 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12805 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12806 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12807 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12808 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12809 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12810 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12811 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12812 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12813 one for an RDP socket.
12814
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012815no-ca-names
12816 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12817 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012818 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012819
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012820no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012822 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012823 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012824 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012825 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12826 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012827
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012828no-tls-tickets
12829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12830 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12831 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012832 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12833 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012834 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12835 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12836 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012837
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012838no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012840 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012841 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012842 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012843 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12844 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012845
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012846no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012848 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012849 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012850 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012851 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12852 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012853
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012854no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012856 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012857 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012858 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012859 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12860 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012861
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012862no-tlsv13
12863 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12864 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12865 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12866 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012867 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12868 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012869
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012870npn <protocols>
12871 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12872 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12873 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012874 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012875 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012876 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12877 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12878 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12879 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12880 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012881
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012882prefer-client-ciphers
12883 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12884 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12885 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012886 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12887 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12888 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012889
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012890process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012891 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012892 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012893 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012894 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12895 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12896 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12897 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012898 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012899 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12900 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12901 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12902 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12903 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012904
12905 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12906
12907 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12908 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12909 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12910 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12911 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12912 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12913 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12914 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012915
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012916proto <name>
12917 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12918 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12919 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12920 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012921 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012922 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012923 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012924 h2" on the bind line.
12925
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012926ssl
12927 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012928 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012929 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12930 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012931 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12932 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012933
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012934ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12935 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012936 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12937 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12938 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012939 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12940
12941ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012942 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12943 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12944 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12945 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012946
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012947strict-sni
12948 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12949 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12950 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12951 See the "crt" option for more information.
12952
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012953tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012954 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012955 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12956 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012957 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012958 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12959 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12960 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12961 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12962 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12963 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12964 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12965
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012966tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012967 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012968 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12969 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12970 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12971 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12972 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12973 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12974 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012975 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12976 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12977 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012978
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012979tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12980 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012981 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12982 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12983 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12984 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12985 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12986 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12987 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12988 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12989 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12990 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012991 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12992 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12993
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012994transparent
12995 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12996 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12997 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12998 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12999 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13000 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13001 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13002 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13003 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13004 so check for support with your vendor.
13005
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013006v4v6
13007 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13008 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13009 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13010 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013011 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013012
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013013v6only
13014 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13015 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13016 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013017 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13018 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013019
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013020uid <uid>
13021 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13022 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13023 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13024 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13025 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13026
13027user <user>
13028 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13029 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13030 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13031 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13032 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13033
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013034verify [none|optional|required]
13035 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13036 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13037 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13038 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13039 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013040 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13041 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13042 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13043 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013044
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200130455.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013046------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013048The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13049which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13050arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13051settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13052after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13053Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13054address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013056 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013057 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013058
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013059Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13060keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013062The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013063
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013064addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013065 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013066 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13067 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13068 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13069 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13070 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013071
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013072agent-check
13073 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013074 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013075 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13076 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13077 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013078
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013079 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013080 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013081 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13082 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13083 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013084
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013085 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13086 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13087 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13088 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13089 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013090
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013091 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013092 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013093
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013094 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13095 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13096 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013097
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013098 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13099 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13100 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013101
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013102 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013103 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13104 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13105 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13106 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013107 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013108 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013109
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013110 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13111 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013112
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013113 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13114 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13115 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13116 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13117 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13118 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13119 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13120 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13121 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013122
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013123 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13124 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013125 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13126 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13127 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013128 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013129
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013130 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013131 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013132
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013133agent-send <string>
13134 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13135 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13136 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13137 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13138 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13139
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013140agent-inter <delay>
13141 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13142 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13143
13144 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13145 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13146 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13147 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13148 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13149 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13150 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13151 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13152 of backends use the same servers.
13153
13154 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13155
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013156agent-addr <addr>
13157 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13158
13159 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13160 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13161 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13162 hostname, it will be resolved.
13163
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013164agent-port <port>
13165 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13166
13167 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13168
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013169allow-0rtt
13170 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013171 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13172 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013173
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013174alpn <protocols>
13175 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13176 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13177 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013178 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013179 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13180 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13181 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13182 now obsolete NPN extension.
13183 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13184 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13185
13186 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013188backup
13189 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13190 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13191 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13192 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013193 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13194 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013195
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013196ca-file <cafile>
13197 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13198 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13199 server's certificate.
13200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013201check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013202 This option enables health checks on a server:
13203 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13204 considered available.
13205 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13206 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13207 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13208 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13209 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13210 set.
13211 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13212 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13213 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13214 exchanges succeed.
13215
13216 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13217 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13218 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13219 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13220 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013221 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013222 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13223
13224 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13225 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13226
13227 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13228 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13229
13230 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13231 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13232 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13233 available.
13234
13235 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13236 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13237 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13238
13239 Example:
13240 # simple tcp check
13241 backend foo
13242 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13243 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13244 backend foo
13245 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13246 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13247 backend foo
13248 option tcp-check
13249 tcp-check connect
13250 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013251
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013252check-send-proxy
13253 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13254 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13255 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13256 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13257 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13258 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13259 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13260
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013261check-alpn <protocols>
13262 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13263 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13264 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13265
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013266check-proto <name>
13267 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13268 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13269 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13270 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013271 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013272 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13273 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13274
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013275check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013276 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013277 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13278 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013279
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013280check-ssl
13281 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13282 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13283 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13284 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013285 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013286 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13287 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013288 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013289 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13290 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013291
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013292check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013293 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013294 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13295 for normal traffic.
13296
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013297ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13299 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13300 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013301 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13302 information and recommendations see e.g.
13303 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13304 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13305 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013306
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013307ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13309 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13310 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13311 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013312 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13313 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13314 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013316cookie <value>
13317 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13318 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13319 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13320 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13321 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13322 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13323 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13324
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013325crl-file <crlfile>
13326 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13327 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13328 to verify server's certificate.
13329
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013330crt <cert>
13331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13332 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13333 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13334 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13335 certificate request.
13336
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013337disabled
13338 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13339 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13340 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13341 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13342 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013343 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013344
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013345enabled
13346 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13347 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13348 default value.
13349 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13350 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013351
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013352error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013353 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13354 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13355 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013357 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013358
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013359fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013360 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13361 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13362 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13363
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013364force-sslv3
13365 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13366 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013367 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013368 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013369
13370force-tlsv10
13371 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013372 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013373 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013374
13375force-tlsv11
13376 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013377 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013378 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013379
13380force-tlsv12
13381 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013382 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013383 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013384
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013385force-tlsv13
13386 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13387 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013388 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013390id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013391 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13392 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13393 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013394
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013395init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13396 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13397 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013398 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013399 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13400 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13401 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13402 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13403 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13404 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13405 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13406 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13407 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013408 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013409 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13410 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13411 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13412 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13413 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13414 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013415 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013416
13417 Example:
13418 defaults
13419 # never fail on address resolution
13420 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013422inter <delay>
13423fastinter <delay>
13424downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013425 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13426 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13427 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13428 between checks depending on the server state :
13429
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013430 Server state | Interval used
13431 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13432 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13433 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13434 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13435 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13436 or yet unchecked. |
13437 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13438 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13439 | "inter" otherwise.
13440 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013442 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13443 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13444 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13445 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013446 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13447 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13448 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13449 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13450 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013451
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013452log-proto <logproto>
13453 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13454 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13455 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13456 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013458maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013459 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13460 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013461 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13462 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013463 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13464 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13465 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13466 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13467
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013468 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13469 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13470 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13471 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13472 than 50 concurrent requests.
13473
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013474maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013475 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13476 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13477 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13478 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013479 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13480 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13481 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13482 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13483 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13484 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13485 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013486
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013487max-reuse <count>
13488 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13489 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13490 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13491 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13492 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13493 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13494 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13495 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013497minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013498 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13499 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13500 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13501 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13502 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13503 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013504 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013505 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013506
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013507namespace <name>
13508 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13509 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13510 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13511 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13512
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013513no-agent-check
13514 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13515 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13516 default value.
13517 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13518 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13519
13520no-backup
13521 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13522 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13523 default value.
13524 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13525 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13526
13527no-check
13528 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13529 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13530 default value.
13531 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13532 "default-server" "check" setting.
13533
13534no-check-ssl
13535 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13536 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13537 default value.
13538 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13539 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13540
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013541no-send-proxy
13542 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13543 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13544 default value.
13545 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13546 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13547
13548no-send-proxy-v2
13549 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13550 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13551 default value.
13552 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13553 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13554
13555no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13556 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13557 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13558 default value.
13559 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13560 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13561
13562no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13563 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13564 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13565 default value.
13566 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13567 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13568
13569no-ssl
13570 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13571 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13572 default value.
13573 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13574 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13575
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010013576 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
13577 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
13578 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
13579
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013580no-ssl-reuse
13581 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13582 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13583 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13584 and for paranoid users.
13585
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013586no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013587 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13588 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013589 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013590
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013591 Supported in default-server: No
13592
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013593no-tls-tickets
13594 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13595 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13596 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013597 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13598 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013599 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13600 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13601 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013602 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013603
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013604no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013605 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013606 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13607 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013608 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13609 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013610 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013611
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013612 Supported in default-server: No
13613
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013614no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013615 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013616 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13617 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013618 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13619 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013620 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013621
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013622 Supported in default-server: No
13623
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013624no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013625 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013626 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13627 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013628 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13629 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013630 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013631
13632 Supported in default-server: No
13633
13634no-tlsv13
13635 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13636 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13637 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13638 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13639 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013640 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013641
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013642 Supported in default-server: No
13643
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013644no-verifyhost
13645 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13646 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13647 default value.
13648 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13649 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013650
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013651no-tfo
13652 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13653 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13654 default value.
13655 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13656 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13657
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013658non-stick
13659 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13660 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13661 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13662
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013663npn <protocols>
13664 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13665 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13666 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013667 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013668 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13669 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13670 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013672observe <mode>
13673 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13674 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13675 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13676 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13677 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13678 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013679 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013680
13681 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013683on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013684 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13685 Currently, four modes are available:
13686 - fastinter: force fastinter
13687 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13688 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13689 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13690 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13691
13692 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13693
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013694on-marked-down <action>
13695 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13696 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013697 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13698 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13699 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13700 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13701 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13702 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13703 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13704 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013705
13706 Actions are disabled by default
13707
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013708on-marked-up <action>
13709 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13710 Currently one action is available:
13711 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13712 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13713 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13714 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013715 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13716 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013717 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13718 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13719
13720 Actions are disabled by default
13721
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013722pool-low-conn <max>
13723 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13724 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13725 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13726 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13727 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13728 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13729 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13730 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13731 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13732 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13733 applying to "http-reuse".
13734
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013735pool-max-conn <max>
13736 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13737 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13738 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13739 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13740 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13741 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13742
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013743pool-purge-delay <delay>
13744 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013745 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013746 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013748port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013749 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13750 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13751 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13752 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13753 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13754 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13755
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013756proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013757 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13758 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13759 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13760 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013761 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013762 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013764redir <prefix>
13765 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13766 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13767 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13768 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13769 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13770 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13771 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13772 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013773 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013774 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013775 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13776 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13777 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13778 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13779
13780 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013782rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013783 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13784 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13785 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13786
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013787resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13788 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13789 server.
13790
13791 Available options:
13792
13793 * allow-dup-ip
13794 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13795 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13796 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13797 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13798 For such case, simply enable this option.
13799 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13800
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013801 * ignore-weight
13802 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13803 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13804 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13805
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013806 * prevent-dup-ip
13807 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13808 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13809 same fqdn.
13810 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13811
13812 Example:
13813 backend b_myapp
13814 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13815 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13816 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13817
13818 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13819 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13820 it
13821 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13822 different address
13823
13824 Default value: not set
13825
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013826resolve-prefer <family>
13827 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13828 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13829 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13830 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13831
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013832 Default value: ipv6
13833
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013834 Example:
13835
13836 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013837
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013838resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013839 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013840 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013841 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013842 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13843 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013844 configured network, another address is selected.
13845
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013846 Example:
13847
13848 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013849
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013850resolvers <id>
13851 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13852 hostname.
13853
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013854 Example:
13855
13856 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013857
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013858 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013859
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013860send-proxy
13861 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13862 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13863 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13864 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013865 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13866 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13867 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13868 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13869 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13870 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13871 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13872 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13873 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13874 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013875 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13876 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013877
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013878send-proxy-v2
13879 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13880 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13881 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13882 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013883 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13884 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13885 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13886 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013887
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013888proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013889 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13890 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13891
13892 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13893 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13894 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13895 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13896 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13897 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13898 connection is supported).
13899 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13900 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13901 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13902 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13903 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13904 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13905 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013906
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013907send-proxy-v2-ssl
13908 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13909 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13910 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13911 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13912 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13913 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13914 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013915 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13916 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013917
13918send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13919 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13920 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13921 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13922 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13923 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13924 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13925 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13926 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013927 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13928 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013930slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013931 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13932 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13933 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13934 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13935 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13936 parameters :
13937
13938 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13939 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13940
13941 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13942 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13943 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13944 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13945
13946 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13947 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13948 seen as failed.
13949
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013950sni <expression>
13951 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13952 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13953 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13954 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013955 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13956 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013957 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013958 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13959 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013960
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013961source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013962source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013963source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013964 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13965 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13966 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13967 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13968
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013969 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13970 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13971 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13972 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13973 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13974 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13975 server.
13976
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013977 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13978 specifying the source address without port(s).
13979
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013980ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013981 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13982 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13983 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13984 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13985 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13986 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013987 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13988 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013989
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013990ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13991 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13992 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13993 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13994
13995ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13996 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13997 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13998 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13999
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014000ssl-reuse
14001 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14002 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14003 default value.
14004 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14005 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14006
14007stick
14008 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14009 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14010 default value.
14011 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14012 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014013
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014014socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014015 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014016 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14017 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14018
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014019tcp-ut <delay>
14020 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14021 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14022 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014023 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014024 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14025 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14026 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14027 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14028 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14029 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14030 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14031 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14032 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14033
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014034tfo
14035 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14036 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14037 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14038 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14039 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014040 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014042track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014043 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14044 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14045 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14046 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014047 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14048
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014049tls-tickets
14050 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14051 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14052 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014053 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14054 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14055 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014056 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014057 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014058
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014059verify [none|required]
14060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014061 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014062 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14063 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014064 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014065 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14066 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14067 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14068 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14069 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14070 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14071 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14072 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014073
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014074verifyhost <hostname>
14075 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014076 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14077 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14078 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14079 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14080 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14081 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14082 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14083 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014085weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014086 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14087 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14088 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014089 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14090 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14091 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14092 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14093 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14094 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014095
14096
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140975.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14098-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014099
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014100HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14101using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14102configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014103This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14104can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14105workload.
14106This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14107resolution at run time.
14108Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14109carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14110
14111
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200141125.3.1. Global overview
14113----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014114
14115As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14116different steps of the process life:
14117
14118 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14119 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14120 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14121
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014122 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14123 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014124
14125A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14126 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14127 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14128 resolution to know this new IP.
14129
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014130When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014131HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014132SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14133from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14134will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14135will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014136
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014137A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014138 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014139 first valid response.
14140
14141 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14142 servers return an error.
14143
14144
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200141455.3.2. The resolvers section
14146----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014147
14148This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014149HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14150contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014151
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014152When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14153uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14154is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14155answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14156
14157When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014158used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014159
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014160 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14161 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14162 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014163
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014164 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14165 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014166
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014167 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14168 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14169 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014170
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014171For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14172following scenarios are possible:
14173
14174 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14175 ignored
14176
14177 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14178 applied
14179
14180 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14181 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14182
14183 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14184 retries the query with a new type
14185
14186 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14187 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014188
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014189As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14190a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014191<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014192
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014193
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014194resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014195 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014196
14197A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14198
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014199accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014200 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014201 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014202 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14203 by RFC 6891)
14204
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014205 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14206
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014207nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14208 DNS server description:
14209 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14210 <ip> : IP address of the server
14211 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14212
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014213parse-resolv-conf
14214 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14215 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14216 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14217
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014218hold <status> <period>
14219 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14220 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014221 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014222 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014223 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14224 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14225 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14226
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014227 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014228
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014229resolve_retries <nb>
14230 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14231 giving up.
14232 Default value: 3
14233
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014234 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14235 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14236 type.
14237
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014238timeout <event> <time>
14239 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14240 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14241 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014242 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14243 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014244 Default value: 1s
14245 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014246 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014247 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014248 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14249 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14250
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014251 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014252
14253 resolvers mydns
14254 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14255 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014256 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014257 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014258 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014259 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014260 hold other 30s
14261 hold refused 30s
14262 hold nx 30s
14263 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014264 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014265 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014266
14267
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200142686. Cache
14269---------
14270
14271HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14272(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14273RAM.
14274
14275The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14276this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14277
14278If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14279independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14280when we try to allocate a new one.
14281
14282The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14283
14284It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14285"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14286for more details.
14287
14288When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14289replaced by "<CACHE>".
14290
14291
142926.1. Limitation
14293----------------
14294
14295The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14296
14297- If the response is not a 200
14298- If the response contains a Vary header
14299- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14300- If the response is not cacheable
14301
14302- If the request is not a GET
14303- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14304- If the request contains an Authorization header
14305
14306
143076.2. Setup
14308-----------
14309
14310To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14311the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14312
14313
143146.2.1. Cache section
14315---------------------
14316
14317cache <name>
14318 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14319 size of cache is mandatory.
14320
14321total-max-size <megabytes>
14322 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14323 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14324
14325max-object-size <bytes>
14326 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14327 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14328 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14329
14330max-age <seconds>
14331 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14332 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14333 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14334 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14335 default.
14336
14337
143386.2.2. Proxy section
14339---------------------
14340
14341http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14342 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14343 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14344 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14345 after this one.
14346
14347http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14348 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14349 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14350 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14351 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14352
14353
14354Example:
14355
14356 backend bck1
14357 mode http
14358
14359 http-request cache-use foobar
14360 http-response cache-store foobar
14361 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14362
14363 cache foobar
14364 total-max-size 4
14365 max-age 240
14366
14367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14369----------------------------------
14370
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014371HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014372client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14373The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14374these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14375but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14376data called patterns.
14377
14378
143797.1. ACL basics
14380---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014381
14382The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14383content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14384from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14385simple :
14386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014387 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014388 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014389 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14390 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014392The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14393adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014394
14395In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014397 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014398
14399This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14400Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14401and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014402an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14403conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14404as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14405are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014406
14407ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14408'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14409which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14410
14411There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14412performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014414The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14415specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14416this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014417methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14418ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014419
14420Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14421 - boolean
14422 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14423 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14424 - string
14425 - data block
14426
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014427Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14428converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14429would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14430The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14431which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14432
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014433Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14434keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14435fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14436which are summarized in the table below :
14437
14438 +---------------------+-----------------+
14439 | Sample or converter | Default |
14440 | output type | matching method |
14441 +---------------------+-----------------+
14442 | boolean | bool |
14443 +---------------------+-----------------+
14444 | integer | int |
14445 +---------------------+-----------------+
14446 | ip | ip |
14447 +---------------------+-----------------+
14448 | string | str |
14449 +---------------------+-----------------+
14450 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14451 +---------------------+-----------------+
14452
14453Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14454matching method, see below.
14455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014456The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14457 - boolean
14458 - integer or integer range
14459 - IP address / network
14460 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14461 - regular expression
14462 - hex block
14463
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014464The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14465
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014466 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14467 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014468 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014469 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014470 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014471 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014472 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014474The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14475read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14476if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14477lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14478will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14479beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14480a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14481lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14482exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14483
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014484The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14485parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14486ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14487a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14488check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14489
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014490The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14491socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14492file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014494Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14495loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14496
14497 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14498
14499In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14500the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14501case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14502as well.
14503
14504The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14505sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14506do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14507methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14508is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014509obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014510followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14511default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14512that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14513string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14514
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014515The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14516By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14517string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14518resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14519server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014520waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014521flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14522function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14525sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14526be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014527
14528 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14529 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014530 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14531 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14532 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14533 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014534
14535 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14536 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014537 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014538
14539 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014540 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014541
14542 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014543 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014544
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014545 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014546 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14547
14548 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14549 binary or string samples.
14550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014551 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14552 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014554 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14555 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14556 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014558 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14559 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014561 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14562 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014564 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14565 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14568 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014569 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014571 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14572 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14573 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014574
14575For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14576request, it is possible to do :
14577
14578 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14579
14580In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14581buffer, one would use the following acl :
14582
14583 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14584
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014585On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14586possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14587
14588 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014590All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14591criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14592method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14593to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14594criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14595the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014597If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014598the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14599For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014601 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14602 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14603 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14604 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014605
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014606
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014607The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14608types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14609combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14610brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14611default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014613 +-------------------------------------------------+
14614 | Input sample type |
14615 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014616 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014617 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14618 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14619 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014620 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014621 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014622 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014623 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014624 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014625 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014626 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014627 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014628 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014629 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014630 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014631 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014632 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014633 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014634 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014635 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014636 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014637 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014638 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014639 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014640 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014641 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14642 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14643 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014644
14645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146467.1.1. Matching booleans
14647------------------------
14648
14649In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14650Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14651When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14652that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14653
14654Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14655return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14656"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14657
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146597.1.2. Matching integers
14660------------------------
14661
14662Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14663enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14664to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14665
14666Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14667matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14668lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014669
14670For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14671unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14672representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14673
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014674As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14675two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14676instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14677ranges and operators.
14678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014679For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014680operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14681Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14682of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014684Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014685
14686 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14687 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14688 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14689 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14690 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014692For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014693
14694 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14695
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014696This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14697
14698 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147017.1.3. Matching strings
14702-----------------------
14703
14704String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14705different forms :
14706
14707 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014708 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014709
14710 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014711 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014712
14713 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14714 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14715
14716 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14717 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14718
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014719 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014720 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14721 matches.
14722
14723 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14724 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14725 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014726
14727String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14728exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14729characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14730string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14731to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014732before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014733
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014734Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14735(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14736Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14737
14738Example:
14739 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14740 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14741
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147437.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14744---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014745
14746Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14747they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14748possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14749passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14750the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014751the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14752match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014753
14754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147557.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14756-------------------------------------
14757
14758It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14759not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14760a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14761to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14762digits may be used upper or lower case.
14763
14764Example :
14765 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14766 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14767
14768
147697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14770---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014771
14772IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14773netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14774within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014775host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014776difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14777at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14778does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14779parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014780
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014781The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14782abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14783
14784 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14785 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14786 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14787 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14788 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14789 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14790 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14791 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14792
14793Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14794192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14795
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014796IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14797Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14798trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14799IPv6 patterns.
14800
14801HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14802following situations :
14803 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14804 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14805 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14806 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14807 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14808 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14809 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14810 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14811 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14812 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014814
148157.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14816----------------------------------
14817
14818Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14819combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14820
14821 - AND (implicit)
14822 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14823 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014829Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14830indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014832For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14833"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14834requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14835is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14836
14837 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014838 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14839 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14840 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014841
14842To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14843and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14844
14845 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14846 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14847 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14848 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14849
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014850 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014851 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14852 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14853 use_backend www if host_www
14854
14855It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14856expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14857be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14858the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14859
14860 The following rule :
14861
14862 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014863 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014864
14865 Can also be written that way :
14866
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014867 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014868
14869It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14870to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14871simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14872sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14873good use is the following :
14874
14875 With named ACLs :
14876
14877 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14878 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14879 monitor fail if site_dead
14880
14881 With anonymous ACLs :
14882
14883 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14884
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014885See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14886keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014887
14888
148897.3. Fetching samples
14890---------------------
14891
14892Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14893against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14894sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14895ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14896of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14897available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14898
14899This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14900Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14901compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14902deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14903
14904The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14905matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14906method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14907indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14908
14909As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14910when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14911mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14912the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14913ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14914
14915Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14916multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14917when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014918incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14919are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14921all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14922
14923Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14924 - name
14925 - name(arg1)
14926 - name(arg1,arg2)
14927
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014928
149297.3.1. Converters
14930-----------------
14931
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014932Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14933of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14934is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14935was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014936has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014937unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14938
14939These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14940sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14941the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014942support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014943
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014944A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14945support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14946supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14947(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14948bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014951
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001495251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14953 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14954 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14955 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14956 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14957 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14958
14959 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014960 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14961 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014962 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14963 frontend http-in
14964 bind *:8081
14965 default_backend servers
14966 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14967 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14968
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014969add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014970 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014971 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014972 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14973 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014974 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014975 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14976 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14977 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14978 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014979 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014980 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014981
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014982aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14983 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14984 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14985 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14986 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14987 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14988 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14989
14990 Example:
14991 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14992 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14993
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014994and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014995 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014996 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014997 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14998 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014999 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015000 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15001 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15002 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15003 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015004 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015005 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015006
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015007b64dec
15008 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15009 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15010
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015011base64
15012 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015013 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015014 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15015
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015016bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015017 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015018 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015019 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015020 presence of a flag).
15021
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015022bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15023 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15024 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015025 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015026
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015027concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15028 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15029 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15030 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15031 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15032 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15033 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15034 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15035 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15036 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15037 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015038 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015039 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015040 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15041 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015042
15043 Example:
15044 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15045 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15046 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015047 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015048 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15049
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015050cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015051 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15052 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015053
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015054crc32([<avalanche>])
15055 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15056 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15057 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15058 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15059 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15060 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15061 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15062 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15063 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15064 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015065 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15066
15067crc32c([<avalanche>])
15068 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15069 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15070 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15071 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15072 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15073 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15074 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15075 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015076
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015077cut_crlf
15078 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15079 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15080 updated.
15081
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015082da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015083 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15084 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15085 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15086 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015087 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015088 configuration language.
15089
15090 Example:
15091 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015092 bind *:8881
15093 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015094 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015095
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015096debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15097 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15098 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15099 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15100 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15101 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15102 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15103 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15104 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15105 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15106 printable sample types.
15107
15108 Example:
15109 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015110
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015111digest(<algorithm>)
15112 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15113 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15114
15115 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15116 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15117
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015118div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015119 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15120 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015121 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015122 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15123 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015124 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015125 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15126 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15127 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15128 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015129 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015130 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015131
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015132djb2([<avalanche>])
15133 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15134 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15135 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15136 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15137 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15138 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15139 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015140 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15141 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015142
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015143even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015144 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015145 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15146
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015147field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15148 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15149 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15150 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15151 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15152 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15153 fields.
15154
15155 Example :
15156 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15157 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15158 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15159 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15160 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015161
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015162fix_is_valid
15163 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15164 Information eXchange):
15165
15166 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15167 numeric
15168 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valide FIX version
15169 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
15170 - checks the MstType tag is the third tag.
15171 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15172 checksum
15173
15174 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15175 the server can be parsed.
15176
15177 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15178 message, false if not.
15179
15180 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15181
15182 Example:
15183 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15184 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15185
15186fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15187 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15188 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15189 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15190 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
15191 MsgType, SenderComID, TargetComID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
15192 added.
15193
15194 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15195 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15196 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15197 fix_is_valid converter.
15198
15199 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15200
15201 Example:
15202 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15203 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15204 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15205 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15206 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15207
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015208hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015209 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015210 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015211 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015212 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015213
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015214hex2i
15215 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015216 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015217
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015218htonl
15219 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15220 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15221 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15222 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15223
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015224hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15225 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15226 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15227 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15228 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15229
15230 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15231 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15232
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015233http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015234 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15235 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015236 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15237 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15238 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15239 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15240 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15241 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15242 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15243 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015244
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015245iif(<true>,<false>)
15246 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15247 string otherwise.
15248
15249 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015250 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015251
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015252in_table(<table>)
15253 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15254 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15255 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015256 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015257 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15258
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015259ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15260 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015261 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015262 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15263 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15264 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15265 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15266 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015267
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015268json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015269 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015270 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015271 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015272 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15273 of errors:
15274 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15275 bytes, ...)
15276 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15277 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15278
15279 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15280 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15281 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15282 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15283 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15284 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015285 - "ascii" : never fails;
15286 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15287 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015288 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015289 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015290 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15291 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15292
15293 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015294 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015295
15296 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015297 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015298 capture request header user-agent len 150
15299 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015300
15301 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15302 GET / HTTP/1.0
15303 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15304
15305 Output log:
15306 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15307
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015308language(<value>[,<default>])
15309 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15310 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15311 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15312 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15313 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15314 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15315 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15316 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15317 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015318 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015319 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15320 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015321
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015322 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015323
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015324 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15325 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015326
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015327 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15328 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15329 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15330 use_backend spanish if es
15331 use_backend french if fr
15332 use_backend english if en
15333 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015334
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015335length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015336 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15337 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15338 type. The result is of type integer.
15339
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015340lower
15341 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15342 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15343 type. The result is of type string.
15344
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015345ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15346 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15347 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15348 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15349 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15350 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15351 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15352
15353 Example :
15354
15355 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015356 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015357 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15358
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015359ltrim(<chars>)
15360 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15361 representation of the input sample.
15362
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015363map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15364map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15365map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15366 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15367 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15368 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15369 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15370 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15371 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15372 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15373 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015374
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015375 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15376 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15377 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015378
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015379 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015380 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015381
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015382 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15383 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15384 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15385 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015386 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15387 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015388 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15389 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15390 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15391 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15392 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15393 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15394 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15395 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015396 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15397 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15398 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015399 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15400 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15401 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15402 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15403 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015404
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015405 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15406 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15407 the corresponding match text.
15408
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015409 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15410 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15411 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15412 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15413 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015414
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015415 Example :
15416
15417 # this is a comment and is ignored
15418 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15419 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15420 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15421 | | | `---------- value
15422 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15423 | `---------------------------- key
15424 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15425
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015426mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015427 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15428 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015429 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015430 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015431 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015432 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15433 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15434 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15435 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015436 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015437 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015438
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015439mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15440 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15441 <packettype>.
15442 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15443 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15444 from.
15445 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15446 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15447 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15448
15449 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15450 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15451 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15452 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15453
15454 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15455 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15456 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15457 packets only):
15458 17: Session Expiry Interval
15459 33: Receive Maximum
15460 39: Maximum Packet Size
15461 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15462 25: Request Response Information
15463 23: Request Problem Information
15464 21: Authentication Method
15465 22: Authentication Data
15466 18: Will Delay Interval
15467 1: Payload Format Indicator
15468 2: Message Expiry Interval
15469 3: Content Type
15470 8: Response Topic
15471 9: Correlation Data
15472 Not supported yet:
15473 38: User Property
15474
15475 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15476 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15477 packets only):
15478 17: Session Expiry Interval
15479 33: Receive Maximum
15480 36: Maximum QoS
15481 37: Retain Available
15482 39: Maximum Packet Size
15483 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15484 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15485 31: Reason String
15486 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15487 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15488 42: Shared Subscription Available
15489 19: Server Keep Alive
15490 26: Response Information
15491 28: Server Reference
15492 21: Authentication Method
15493 22: Authentication Data
15494 Not supported yet:
15495 38: User Property
15496
15497 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15498 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15499 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15500 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15501
15502 Example:
15503
15504 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15505 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15506 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15507 if data_in_buffer
15508 # do the same as above
15509 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15510 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15511 if data_in_buffer
15512
15513mqtt_is_valid
15514 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15515
15516 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15517 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15518 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15519 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15520
15521 Example:
15522
15523 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15524 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15525
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015526mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015527 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015528 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15529 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015530 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015531 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015532 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015533 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15534 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15535 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15536 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015537 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015538 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015539
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015540nbsrv
15541 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15542 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15543 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15544 map lookup.
15545
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015546neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015547 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15548 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15549 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15550 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015551
15552not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015553 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015554 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015555 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015556 absence of a flag).
15557
15558odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015559 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015560 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15561
15562or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015563 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015564 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015565 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15566 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015567 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015568 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15569 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15570 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15571 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015572 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015573 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015574
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015575protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15576 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15577 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15578 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15579 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15580 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15581 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15582 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15583 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15584 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15585 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15586 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15587
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015588regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015589 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15590 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15591 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15592 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15593 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15594 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15595 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15596 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15597 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015598 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15599 of characters with other ones.
15600
15601 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15602 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15603 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15604 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15605 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15606 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015607
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015608 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015609
15610 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15611 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15612 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015613 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015614
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015615 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15616 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15617
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015618 # capture groups and backreferences
15619 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015620 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015621 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15622
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015623capture-req(<id>)
15624 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15625 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15626
15627 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015628 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15629 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015630
15631capture-res(<id>)
15632 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15633 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15634
15635 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015636 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15637 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015638
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015639rtrim(<chars>)
15640 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15641 of the input sample.
15642
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015643sdbm([<avalanche>])
15644 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15645 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15646 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15647 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15648 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15649 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15650 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015651 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15652 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015653
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015654secure_memcmp(<var>)
15655 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15656 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15657 match.
15658
15659 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15660 performed in constant time.
15661
15662 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15663 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15664
15665 Example :
15666
15667 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15668 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15669 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15670 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15671
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015672set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015673 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15674 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15675 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015676 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015677 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15678 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015679 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015680 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15681 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015682 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015683 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015684
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015685sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015686 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015687 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15688
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015689sha2([<bits>])
15690 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15691 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15692
15693 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15694 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15695
15696 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15697 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15698
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015699srv_queue
15700 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15701 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15702 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15703 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15704 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15705
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015706strcmp(<var>)
15707 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15708 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15709 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15710 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15711 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15712 shorter).
15713
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015714 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15715 strings in constant time.
15716
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015717 Example :
15718
15719 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15720 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15721 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15722
15723
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015724sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015725 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15726 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015727 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015728 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15729 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015730 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015731 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15732 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015733 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015734 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15735 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015736 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015737 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015738
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015739table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15740 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15741 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15742 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15743 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15744 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15745 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15746
15747
15748table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15749 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15750 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15751 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15752 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15753 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15754 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15755
15756table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15757 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15758 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015759 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015760 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15761 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15762
15763table_conn_cur(<table>)
15764 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15765 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15766 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15767 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15768 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15769
15770table_conn_rate(<table>)
15771 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15772 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15773 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15774 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15775 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15776
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015777table_gpt0(<table>)
15778 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15779 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15780 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15781 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15782 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15783
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015784table_gpc0(<table>)
15785 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15786 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15787 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15788 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15789 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15790
15791table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15792 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15793 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15794 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15795 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15796 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15797 sample fetch keyword.
15798
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015799table_gpc1(<table>)
15800 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15801 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15802 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15803 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15804 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15805
15806table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15807 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15808 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15809 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15810 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15811 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15812 sample fetch keyword.
15813
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015814table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15815 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15816 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015817 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015818 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15819 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15820
15821table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15822 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15823 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15824 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15825 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15826 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15827 keyword.
15828
15829table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15830 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15831 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015832 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015833 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15834 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15835
15836table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15837 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15838 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15839 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15840 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15841 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15842 keyword.
15843
15844table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15845 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15846 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015847 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015848 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15849 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15850 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15851 keyword.
15852
15853table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15854 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15855 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015856 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015857 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15858 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15859 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15860 keyword.
15861
15862table_server_id(<table>)
15863 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15864 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15865 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15866 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15867 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15868 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15869
15870table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15871 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15872 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015873 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015874 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15875 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15876 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15877 keyword.
15878
15879table_sess_rate(<table>)
15880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15883 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15884 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15885 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15886 keyword.
15887
15888table_trackers(<table>)
15889 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15890 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15891 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15892 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15893 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15894 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15895 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15896 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15897 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15898 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15899
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015900upper
15901 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15902 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15903 type. The result is of type string.
15904
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015905url_dec([<in_form>])
15906 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15907 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15908 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15909 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15910 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15911 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015912
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015913ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015914 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015915 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15916 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15917 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015918 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15919 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15920 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15921 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015922 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015923 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15924 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015925
15926 Example:
15927 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15928 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15929
15930 message Point {
15931 int32 latitude = 1;
15932 int32 longitude = 2;
15933 }
15934
15935 message PPoint {
15936 Point point = 59;
15937 }
15938
15939 message Rectangle {
15940 // One corner of the rectangle.
15941 PPoint lo = 48;
15942 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15943 PPoint hi = 49;
15944 }
15945
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015946 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15947 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15948 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015949
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015950 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15951 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015952 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015953 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15954
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015955 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015956
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015957 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015958
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015959 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15960 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15961 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015962
15963 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15964 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15965 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15966
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015967 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15968 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15969 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015970
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015971
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015972unset-var(<var name>)
15973 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15974 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15975 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15976 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15977 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15978 response),
15979 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15980 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15981 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15982 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15983
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015984utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15985 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15986 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15987 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15988 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15989 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15990 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15991
15992 Example :
15993
15994 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015995 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015996 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15997
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015998word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15999 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16000 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16001 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016002 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016003 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16004 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16005
16006 Example :
16007 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16008 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16009 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16010 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16011 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016012 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016013
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016014wt6([<avalanche>])
16015 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16016 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16017 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16018 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16019 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16020 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16021 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016022 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16023 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016024
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016025xor(<value>)
16026 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016027 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016028 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016029 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016030 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016031 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16032 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016033 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016034 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16035 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016036 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016037 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016038
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016039xxh32([<seed>])
16040 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16041 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16042 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16043 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16044 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16045 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16046 as cryptographically secure.
16047
16048xxh64([<seed>])
16049 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16050 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16051 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16052 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16053 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16054 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16055 as cryptographically secure.
16056
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016057
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160587.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059--------------------------------------------
16060
16061A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16062not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16063"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16064The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16065
16066always_false : boolean
16067 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16068 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16069
16070always_true : boolean
16071 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16072 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16073
16074avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016075 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016076 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16077 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16078 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16079 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16080 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16081 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16082 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16083 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16084 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16085 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16086 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16087 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16088 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016091 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16092 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16093 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16094 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016095 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16096
16097be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16098 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16099 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16100 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16101 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16102 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016103 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16104 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016105
16106 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16107 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16108 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016110be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16111 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16112 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16113 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016114 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16116 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016117
16118 Example :
16119 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16120 backend dynamic
16121 mode http
16122 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16123 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016124
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016125bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016126 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16127 of the string.
16128
16129bool(<bool>) : bool
16130 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16131 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016133connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16134 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016135 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16137 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016138
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016139 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016140 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016141 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16142
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016143 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16144 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016145
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016146 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016147 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016149 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016150 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016151 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016152 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016153
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016154 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16155 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016157 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016158
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016159cpu_calls : integer
16160 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16161 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16162 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16163 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16164 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16165 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16166
16167cpu_ns_avg : integer
16168 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16169 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16170 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16171 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16172 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16173 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16174 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16175 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16176 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16177 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16178 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16179
16180cpu_ns_tot : integer
16181 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16182 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16183 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16184 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16185 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16186 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16187 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16188 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16189 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16190 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16191 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16192 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16193 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16194
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016195date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016196 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016197
16198 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16199 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16200 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016201 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16202
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016203 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16204 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16205 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16206 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16207 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16208
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016209 Example :
16210
16211 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16212 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016213
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016214 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16215 # millisecond granularity
16216 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16217
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016218date_us : integer
16219 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16220 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16221 from the same timeval structure.
16222
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016223distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16224 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16225 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16226 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16227 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16228 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16229 list of supported tokens.
16230
16231distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16232 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16233 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16234 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16235 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16236 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16237 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16238 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16239 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16240 supported tokens.
16241
16242 Example :
16243 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16244 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16245 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16246 # send large files to the big farm
16247 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16248
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016249env(<name>) : string
16250 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16251 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16252 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16253 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16254 certain way.
16255
16256 Examples :
16257 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16258 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16259
16260 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16261 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016263fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16264 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016265 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16266 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16268 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016269 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016270 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16271 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016272
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016273fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16274 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16275 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16276 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16279 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16280 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16281 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16282 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16283 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16284 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16285 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16286 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016287
16288 Example :
16289 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16290 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16291 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16292 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16293 frontend mail
16294 bind :25
16295 mode tcp
16296 maxconn 100
16297 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16298 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16299 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16300 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016301
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016302hostname : string
16303 Returns the system hostname.
16304
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016305int(<integer>) : signed integer
16306 Returns a signed integer.
16307
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016308ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16309 Returns an ipv4.
16310
16311ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16312 Returns an ipv6.
16313
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016314lat_ns_avg : integer
16315 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16316 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16317 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16318 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16319 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16320 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16321 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16322 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16323 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016324 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16325 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16326 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16327 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16328 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16329 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016330
16331lat_ns_tot : integer
16332 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16333 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16334 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16335 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16336 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16337 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16338 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16339 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16340 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016341 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16342 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16343 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16344 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16345 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016346 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16347 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16348 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16349 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16350 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16351 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16352
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016353meth(<method>) : method
16354 Returns a method.
16355
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016356nbproc : integer
16357 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16358 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16359 and debugging purposes.
16360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016361nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16362 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16363 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16364 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016365 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16366 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16367 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016368
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016369prio_class : integer
16370 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16371 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16372 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16373
16374prio_offset : integer
16375 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16376 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16377 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16378 set-priority-offset".
16379
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016380proc : integer
16381 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16382 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16383 debugging purposes.
16384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016385queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016386 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16387 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16388 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016389 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16390 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16391 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16392 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16393 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16394
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016395rand([<range>]) : integer
16396 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16397 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16398 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16399 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16400 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16401
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016402uuid([<version>]) : string
16403 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16404 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16405 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016407srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16408 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16409 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16410 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16411 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16412 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016413 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16414 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16415
16416srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16417 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16418 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16419 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16420 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16421 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16422 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16423 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16424
16425 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16426 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016427
16428srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16429 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16430 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16431 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016432 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016433 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16434 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16435 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16436
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016437srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16438 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16439 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16440 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16441 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16442 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16443 fetch methods.
16444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016445srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16446 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16447 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016448 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016449 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16450 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016451 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016452 overloading servers).
16453
16454 Example :
16455 # Redirect to a separate back
16456 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16457 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16458 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16459
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016460srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16461 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16462 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16463 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16464
16465srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16466 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16467 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16468 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16469
16470srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16471 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16472 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16473 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16474
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016475stopping : boolean
16476 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16477 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16478 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16479
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016480str(<string>) : string
16481 Returns a string.
16482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016483table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16484 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16485 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16486
16487table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16488 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16489 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16490 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16491
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016492thread : integer
16493 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16494 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16495 and debugging purposes.
16496
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016497var(<var-name>) : undefined
16498 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016499 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16500 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016501 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016502 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16503 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016504 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016505 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16506 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016507 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016508 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016509
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200165107.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016511----------------------------------
16512
16513The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16514closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16515methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16516sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16517TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016518the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16519counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016520"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16521used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16522can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16523Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16524table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16525tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16526currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016527
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016528bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016529 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16530 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16531 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016533be_id : integer
16534 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016535 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16536 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016537
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016538be_name : string
16539 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016540 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16541 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016543dst : ip
16544 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16545 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16546 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16547 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016548 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16549 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16550 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16551 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16552 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16553 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016554
16555dst_conn : integer
16556 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16557 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16558 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16559 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16560 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16561 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16562 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16563 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016564
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016565dst_is_local : boolean
16566 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16567 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16568 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16569 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016570 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016571 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16572 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16573 it only once per connection.
16574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016575dst_port : integer
16576 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16577 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16578 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16579 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16580 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16581 an HTTP header.
16582
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016583fc_http_major : integer
16584 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16585 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16586 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16587
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016588fc_pp_authority : string
16589 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16590 if any.
16591
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016592fc_pp_unique_id : string
16593 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16594 if any.
16595
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016596fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16597 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16598 header.
16599
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016600fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16601 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16602 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16603 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16604 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16605 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16606 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16607
16608fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16609 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16610 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16611 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16612 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16613 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16614 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16615
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016616fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016617 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16618 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16619 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16620 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16621
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016622fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016623 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16624 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16625 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16626 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16627
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016628fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016629 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16630 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16631 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16632 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16633
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016634fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016635 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16636 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16637 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16638 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16639
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016640fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016641 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16642 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16643 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16644 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16645
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016646fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016647 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16648 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16649 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16650 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16651
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016652fe_defbe : string
16653 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16654 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016656fe_id : integer
16657 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016658 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016659 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16660
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016661fe_name : string
16662 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16663 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16664 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16665
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016666sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016667sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16668sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16669sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016670 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16671 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16672 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16673
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016674sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016675sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16676sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16677sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016678 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16679 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16680 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16681
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016682sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016683sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16684sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16685sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016686 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16687 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016688 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16689 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16690 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016691
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016692 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016693 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16694 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016695 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16696 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16697 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016698 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16699 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16700
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016701sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16702sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16703sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16704sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16705 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16706 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16707 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16708 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16709 when a first ACL was verified.
16710
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016711sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016712sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16713sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16714sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016715 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016716 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16717
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016718sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016719sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16720sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16721sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016722 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16723 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16724 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16725
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016726sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016727sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16728sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16729sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016730 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16731 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16732 See also src_conn_rate.
16733
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016734sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016735sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16736sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16737sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016738 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016739 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016740
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016741sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16742sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16743sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16744sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16745 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16746 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16747
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016748sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16749sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16750sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16751sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16752 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16753 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16754
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016755sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016756sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16757sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16758sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016759 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16760 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16761 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016762 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16763 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16764 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016765
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016766sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16767sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16768sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16769sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16770 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16771 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16772 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16773 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16774 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16775 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016777sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016778sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16779sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16780sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016781 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016782 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16783 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16784
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016785sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016786sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16787sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16788sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016789 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16790 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16791 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16792 src_http_err_rate.
16793
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016794sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016795sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16796sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16797sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016798 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016799 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16800 src_http_req_cnt.
16801
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016802sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016803sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16804sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16805sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016806 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16807 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16808 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16809 src_http_req_rate.
16810
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016811sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016812sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16813sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16814sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016815 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016816 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16817 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16818 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16819 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016820
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016821 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016822 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16823 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016824 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16825
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016826sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16827sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16828sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16829sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16830 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16831 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16832 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16833 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16834 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16835
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016836sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016837sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16838sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16839sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016840 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16841 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16842 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016843
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016844sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016845sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16846sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16847sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016848 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16849 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16850 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016851
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016852sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016853sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16854sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16855sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016856 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016857 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16858 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16859 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016860 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016861 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16862
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016863sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016864sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16865sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16866sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016867 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16868 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16869 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16870 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16871 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016872 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016873
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016874sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016875sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16876sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16877sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016878 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16879 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16880 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16881
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016882sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016883sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16884sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16885sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016886 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16887 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016888 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016889 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16890 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016891 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16892 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16893 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016895so_id : integer
16896 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16897 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16898 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016899
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016900so_name : string
16901 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16902 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16903 strings instead of integers.
16904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016905src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016906 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016907 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16908 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16909 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016910 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16911 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16912 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016913 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16914 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16915 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16916 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16917 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16918 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16919 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016920
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016921 Example:
16922 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16923 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016925src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16926 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16927 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16928 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016929 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016931src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16932 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16933 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016934 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016935 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016937src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16938 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16939 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16940 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16941 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16942 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16943 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016944
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016945 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016946 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16947 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16948 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16949 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016950 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016951 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16952 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16953
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016954src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16955 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16956 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16957 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16958 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16959 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16960 was verified.
16961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016962src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016963 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016964 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016965 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016966 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016968src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016969 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016970 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16971 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016972 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016974src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16975 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16976 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16977 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016978 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016980src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016981 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016982 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016983 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016984 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016985
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016986src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16987 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16988 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16989 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16990 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16991
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016992src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16993 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16994 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16995 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16996 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016998src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016999 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017000 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017001 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17002 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017003 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17004 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17005 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017006
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017007src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17008 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17009 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17010 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17011 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17012 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17013 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17014 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017016src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017017 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017018 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017019 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017020 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017021 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017023src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17024 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17025 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17026 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17027 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017028 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017030src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017031 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017032 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17033 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017034 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017036src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17037 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17038 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17039 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017040 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017041 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017043src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17044 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17045 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17046 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017047 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017048 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17049 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017050
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017051 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017052 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017053 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017054 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017055
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017056src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17057 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17058 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17059 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17060 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17061 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17062 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17063
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017064src_is_local : boolean
17065 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17066 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17067 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17068 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017069 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017070 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17071 once per connection.
17072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017073src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017074 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17075 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17076 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17077 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17078 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017080src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017081 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17082 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17083 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17084 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17085 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017087src_port : integer
17088 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17089 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17090 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17091 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017093src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017094 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017095 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17096 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17097 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017098 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017100src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17101 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17102 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17103 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17104 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017105 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017107src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17108 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17109 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17110 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17111 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17112 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17113 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17114 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17115 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017116
17117 Example :
17118 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17119 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17120 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17121 listen ssh
17122 bind :22
17123 mode tcp
17124 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017125 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017126 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017127 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017129srv_id : integer
17130 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17131 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017132 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017133
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017134srv_name : string
17135 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17136 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017137 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017138
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200171397.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017140----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017142The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17143closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17144when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17145usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017146future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017147
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001714851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17149 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17150 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17151 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17152 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17153 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17154
17155 Example :
17156 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17157 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17158 # the request.
17159 frontend http-in
17160 bind *:8081
17161 default_backend servers
17162 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17163 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17164
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017165ssl_bc : boolean
17166 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17167 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017168 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17169 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017170
17171ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17172 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017173 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17174 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017175
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017176ssl_bc_alpn : string
17177 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17178 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017179 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017180 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17181 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17182 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17183 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17184 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017185 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17186 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017187
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017188ssl_bc_cipher : string
17189 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017190 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17191 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017192
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017193ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17194 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17195 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17196 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017197 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017198
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017199ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17200 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17201 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017202 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17203 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017204
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017205ssl_bc_npn : string
17206 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17207 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017208 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017209 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17210 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17211 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17212 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017213 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17214 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017215
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017216ssl_bc_protocol : string
17217 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017218 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17219 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017220
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017221ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017222 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017223 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017224 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17225 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017226
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017227ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17228 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17229 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17230 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017231 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017232
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017233ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17234 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17235 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017236 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17237 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017238
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017239ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17240 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17241 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17242 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017243 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017244
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017245ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17246 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017247 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17248 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017250ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17251 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17252 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17253 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17254 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17255 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017257ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17258 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17259 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17260 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17261 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017262
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017263ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017264 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17265 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17266 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17267 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17268 does not support resumed sessions.
17269
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017270ssl_c_der : binary
17271 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17272 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17273 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017275ssl_c_err : integer
17276 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17277 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17278 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17279 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17280 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017281
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017282ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017283 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17284 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17285 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17286 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17287 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17288 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17289 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17290 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017291 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17292 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17293 LDAP v3.
17294 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17295 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017297ssl_c_key_alg : string
17298 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17299 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17300 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017302ssl_c_notafter : string
17303 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17304 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17305 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017307ssl_c_notbefore : string
17308 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17309 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17310 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017311
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017312ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017313 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17314 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17315 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17316 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17317 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17318 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17319 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17320 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017321 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17322 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17323 LDAP v3.
17324 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17325 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017327ssl_c_serial : binary
17328 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17329 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17330 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017332ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17333 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17334 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17335 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017336 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17337 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17338
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017339 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017340 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017342ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17343 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17344 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17345 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017347ssl_c_used : boolean
17348 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17349 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017351ssl_c_verify : integer
17352 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17353 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17354 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17355 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017357ssl_c_version : integer
17358 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17359 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017360
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017361ssl_f_der : binary
17362 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17363 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17364 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17365
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017366ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017367 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17368 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17369 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17370 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017371 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017372 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17373 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17374 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017375 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17376 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17377 LDAP v3.
17378 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17379 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017381ssl_f_key_alg : string
17382 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17383 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17384 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017386ssl_f_notafter : string
17387 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17388 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17389 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017391ssl_f_notbefore : string
17392 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17393 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17394 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017395
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017396ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017397 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17398 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17399 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17400 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17401 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17402 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17403 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17404 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017405 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17406 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17407 LDAP v3.
17408 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17409 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017411ssl_f_serial : binary
17412 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17413 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17414 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017415
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017416ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17417 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17418 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17419 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017421ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17422 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17423 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17424 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017426ssl_f_version : integer
17427 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17428 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17429
17430ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017431 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17432 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17433 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017435 Example :
17436 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17437 listen http-https
17438 bind :80
17439 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17440 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17441
17442ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17443 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17444 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17445
17446ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017447 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017448 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17449 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17450 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17451 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17452 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17453 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17454 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17455 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017457ssl_fc_cipher : string
17458 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17459 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017460
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017461ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17462 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17463 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017464 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017465
17466ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17467 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17468 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017469 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017470
17471ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17472 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17473 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17474 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017475 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017476 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017477
17478ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17479 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17480 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017481 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017482
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017483ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17484 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17485 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17486 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17487
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017488ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17489 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17490 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17491 transport layer.
17492 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17493 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17494 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17495 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17496
17497ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17498 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17499 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17500 transport layer.
17501 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17502 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17503 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17504 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17505
17506ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17507 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17508 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17509 transport layer.
17510 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17511 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17512 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17513 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17514
17515ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17516 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17517 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17518 transport layer.
17519 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17520 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17521 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17522 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17523
17524ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17525 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17526 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17527 transport layer.
17528 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17529 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17530 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17531 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017533ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017534 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17535 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017536 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17537 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17538 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17539 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017540
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017541ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17542 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17543 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17544 wait until the handshake happened.
17545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017546ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17547 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017548 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17549 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017550 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017551 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017552
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017553ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017554 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017555 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17556 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017558ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017559 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017560 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17561 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17562 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17563 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17564 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17565 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17566 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017568ssl_fc_protocol : string
17569 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17570 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017571
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017572ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017573 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017574 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17575 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017576
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017577ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17578 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17579 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17580 transport layer.
17581 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17582 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17583 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17584 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17585
17586ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17587 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17588 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17589 transport layer.
17590 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17591 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17592 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17593 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17594
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017595ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17596 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17597 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17598 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017600ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17601 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17602 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17603 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17604 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017605
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017606ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17607 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17608 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17609 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17610 BoringSSL.
17611
17612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017613ssl_fc_sni : string
17614 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17615 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17616 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17617 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17618 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17619
17620 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17621 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17622 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017623 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017624 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017626 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017627 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17628 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017630ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17631 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17632 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017633
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017634ssl_s_der : binary
17635 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17636 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17637 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17638
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017639ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17640 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17641 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17642 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17643 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17644 does not support resumed sessions.
17645
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017646ssl_s_key_alg : string
17647 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17648 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17649 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17650
17651ssl_s_notafter : string
17652 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17653 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17654 transport layer.
17655
17656ssl_s_notbefore : string
17657 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17658 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17659 transport layer.
17660
17661ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17662 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17663 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17664 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17665 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17666 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17667 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017668 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17669 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017670 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17671 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17672 LDAP v3.
17673 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17674 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17675
17676ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17677 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17678 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17679 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17680 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17681 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17682 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017683 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17684 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017685 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17686 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17687 LDAP v3.
17688 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17689 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17690
17691ssl_s_serial : binary
17692 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17693 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17694 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17695
17696ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17697 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17698 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17699 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17700
17701ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17702 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17703 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17704 layer.
17705
17706ssl_s_version : integer
17707 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17708 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017709
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177107.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017711------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017713Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17714sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17715only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17716For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17717be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17718can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17719sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17720for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17721content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017723payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017724 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017725 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17726 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017728payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17729 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017730 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017731 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017732
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017733req.hdrs : string
17734 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17735 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17736 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17737 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17738
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017739req.hdrs_bin : binary
17740 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17741 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17742 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17743 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17744 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17745 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17746
17747 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17748
17749 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17750 str: <int:length><bytes>
17751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017752req.len : integer
17753req_len : integer (deprecated)
17754 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17755 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17756 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17757 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17758 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17759 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17760 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17761 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017763req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17764 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017765 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17766 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17767 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17768 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017770 ACL alternatives :
17771 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017773req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17774 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17775 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17776 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17777 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017779 ACL alternatives :
17780 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017782 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017784req.proto_http : boolean
17785req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17786 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17787 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17788 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17789 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17790 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17791 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17792 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017794 Example:
17795 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17796 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17797 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017798 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017800req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17801rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17802 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17803 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17804 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17805 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17806 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17807 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17808 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017810 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17811 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17812 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17813 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17814 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17815 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017817 ACL derivatives :
17818 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017820 Example :
17821 listen tse-farm
17822 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17823 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17824 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17825 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17826 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17827 persist rdp-cookie
17828 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17829 # This is only useful makes sense if
17830 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17831 stick-table type string size 204800
17832 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17833 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17834 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017836 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17837 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017839req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17840rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17841 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17842 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17843 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17844 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017846 ACL derivatives :
17847 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017848
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017849req.ssl_alpn : string
17850 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17851 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17852 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17853 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17854 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17855 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017856 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017857
17858 Examples :
17859 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17860 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17861 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017862 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017863 default_backend bk_default
17864
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017865req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17866 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17867 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017868 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17869 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17870 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17871 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17872 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017874req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17875req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17876 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17877 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17878 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17879 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17880 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17881 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17882 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017884req.ssl_sni : string
17885req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17886 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17887 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17888 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17889 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17890 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017891 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17892 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17893 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17894 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17895 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17896 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17897 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17898 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17899 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017901 ACL derivatives :
17902 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017904 Examples :
17905 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17906 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17907 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17908 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17909 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017910
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017911req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17912 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17913 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17914 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17915 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17916 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17917 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17918 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17919 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17920 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017922req.ssl_ver : integer
17923req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17924 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17925 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17926 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17927 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17928 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17929 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17930 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017931 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017932 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017934 ACL derivatives :
17935 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017936
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017937res.len : integer
17938 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17939 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17940 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17941 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17942 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17943 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17944 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017945 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017947res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17948 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017949 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017950 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017951 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017952 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017954res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17955 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17956 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17957 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017958 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17959 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017961 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017962
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017963res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17964rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17965 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17966 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17967 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17968 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17969 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17970 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17971 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017973wait_end : boolean
17974 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17975 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017976 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017977 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17978 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017979 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017980 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17981 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017983 Examples :
17984 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17985 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17986 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017988 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17989 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17990 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17991 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17992 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17993 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17994 tcp-request content reject
17995
17996
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200179977.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017998--------------------------------------
17999
18000It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18001This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18002data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18003its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18004HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18005content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18006to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18007more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18008response are indexed.
18009
18010base : string
18011 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18012 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18013 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18014 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18015 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18016 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18017 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18018 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18019
18020 ACL derivatives :
18021 base : exact string match
18022 base_beg : prefix match
18023 base_dir : subdir match
18024 base_dom : domain match
18025 base_end : suffix match
18026 base_len : length match
18027 base_reg : regex match
18028 base_sub : substring match
18029
18030base32 : integer
18031 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18032 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18033 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018034 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18035 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18036 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018037
18038base32+src : binary
18039 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18040 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18041 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18042 per-URL counters.
18043
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018044capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18045 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18046 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18047 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18048
18049capture.req.method : string
18050 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18051 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18052 because it's allocated.
18053
18054capture.req.uri : string
18055 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18056 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18057 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18058 allocated.
18059
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018060capture.req.ver : string
18061 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18062 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18063 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18064
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018065capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18066 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18067 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18068 The first entry is an index of 0.
18069 See also: "capture response header"
18070
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018071capture.res.ver : string
18072 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18073 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18074 persistent flag.
18075
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018076req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018077 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18078 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18079 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018080
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018081req.body_param([<name>) : string
18082 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18083 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18084 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18085 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18086 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18087 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18088 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18089 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18090 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18091 given.
18092
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018093req.body_len : integer
18094 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18095 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018096 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18097 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018098
18099req.body_size : integer
18100 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018101 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18102 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018104req.cook([<name>]) : string
18105cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18106 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18107 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18108 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18109 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18110 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18111 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18112 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18113 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18114
18115 ACL derivatives :
18116 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18117 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18118 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18119 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18120 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18121 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18122 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18123 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018125req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18126cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18127 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18128 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018130req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18131cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18132 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18133 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18134 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18135 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018137cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18138 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18139 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18140 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18141 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018142 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018143 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18144 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18145 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18146 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018148hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18149 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18150 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18151 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18152 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018153 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018155req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
18156 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18157 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18158 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18159 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18160 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18161 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
18162 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
18163 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018165req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18166 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18167 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18168 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18169 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018171req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18172 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18173 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18174 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18175 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18176 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18177 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18178 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18179 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018180 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018181 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018182 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018184 ACL derivatives :
18185 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18186 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18187 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18188 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18189 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18190 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18191 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18192 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18193
18194req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18195hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18196 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18197 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18198 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18199 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18200 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18201 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18202 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18203 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18204 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18205
18206req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18207hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18208 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18209 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18210 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18211 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18212 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018213 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018214 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18215 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18216
18217req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18218hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18219 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18220 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18221 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18222 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18223 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18224 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18225 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18226
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018227
18228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018229http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18230 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18231 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18232 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18233 basic auth is supported.
18234
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018235http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18236 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18237 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18238 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18239 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018240 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18241 basic auth is supported.
18242
18243 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018244 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18245 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18246 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18247 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018248
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018249http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018250 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18251 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18252 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018253
18254http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018255 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18256 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18257 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018258
18259http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018260 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18261 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18262 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018264http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018265 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18266 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018267 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18268 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018270method : integer + string
18271 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18272 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18273 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18274 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18275 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18276 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18277 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018279 ACL derivatives :
18280 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018282 Example :
18283 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18284 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18285 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018287path : string
18288 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18289 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18290 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18291 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18292 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018293 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018294 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018296 ACL derivatives :
18297 path : exact string match
18298 path_beg : prefix match
18299 path_dir : subdir match
18300 path_dom : domain match
18301 path_end : suffix match
18302 path_len : length match
18303 path_reg : regex match
18304 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018305
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018306pathq : string
18307 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18308 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18309 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18310 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18311 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18312 result in both cases.
18313
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018314query : string
18315 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18316 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18317 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18318 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018319 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018320 which stops before the question mark.
18321
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018322req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18323 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18324 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18325 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18326 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018328req.ver : string
18329req_ver : string (deprecated)
18330 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18331 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18332 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018334 ACL derivatives :
18335 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018336
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018337res.body : binary
18338 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18339 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18340 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18341 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18342
18343res.body_len : integer
18344 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18345 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18346 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18347 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18348
18349res.body_size : integer
18350 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18351 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18352 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18353 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18354 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18355 based expect rules.
18356
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018357res.cache_hit : boolean
18358 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18359 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18360
18361res.cache_name : string
18362 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18363 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18364 empty string.
18365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018366res.comp : boolean
18367 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18368 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18369 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371res.comp_algo : string
18372 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18373 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18374 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018376res.cook([<name>]) : string
18377scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18378 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18379 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018380 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18381 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018383 ACL derivatives :
18384 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018386res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18387scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18388 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18389 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018390 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18391 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018393res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18394scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18395 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18396 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018397 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18398 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018400res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18401 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18402 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18403 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18404 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18405 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18406 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18407 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18408 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018409 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018411res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18412 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18413 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18414 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18415 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018416 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18417 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018419res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18420shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18421 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18422 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18423 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18424 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18425 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18426 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18427 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018428 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18429 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018431 ACL derivatives :
18432 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18433 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18434 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18435 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18436 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18437 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18438 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18439 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18440
18441res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18442shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18443 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18444 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18445 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18446 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018447 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018449res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18450shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18451 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18452 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18453 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18454 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18455 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018456 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18457 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018458
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018459res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18460 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18461 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18462 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018463 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18464 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018466res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18467shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18468 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18469 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18470 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18471 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18472 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018473 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18474 based expect rules.
18475
18476res.hdrs : string
18477 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18478 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18479 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18480 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18481 based expect rules.
18482
18483res.hdrs_bin : binary
18484 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18485 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18486 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18487 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18488 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18489 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18490 (length of 0 for both).
18491
18492 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18493
18494 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18495 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018497res.ver : string
18498resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18499 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018500 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18501 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018503 ACL derivatives :
18504 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018506set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18507 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18508 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018509 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018510 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018512 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18513 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018515status : integer
18516 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18517 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018518 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18519 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018520
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018521unique-id : string
18522 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18523 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18524 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18525 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18526 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18527 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018529url : string
18530 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18531 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18532 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18533 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18534 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18535 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18536 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018538 ACL derivatives :
18539 url : exact string match
18540 url_beg : prefix match
18541 url_dir : subdir match
18542 url_dom : domain match
18543 url_end : suffix match
18544 url_len : length match
18545 url_reg : regex match
18546 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018548url_ip : ip
18549 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18550 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18551 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18552 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18553 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18554 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18555 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018557url_port : integer
18558 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18559 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18560 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18561 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018562
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018563urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18564url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018565 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18566 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018567 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18568 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18569 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18570 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018571 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18572 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018573 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18574 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018576 ACL derivatives :
18577 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18578 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18579 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18580 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18581 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18582 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18583 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18584 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018585
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018587 Example :
18588 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18589 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18590 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18591 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018592
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018593urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018594 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18595 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18596 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018597
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018598url32 : integer
18599 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18600 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18601 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18602 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18603 is an unsigned integer.
18604
18605url32+src : binary
18606 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18607 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18608 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18609
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018610
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200186117.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018612---------------------------------------
18613
18614This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18615used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18616purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18617There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18618or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18619any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18620for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18621
18622internal.htx.data : integer
18623 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18624 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18625
18626internal.htx.free : integer
18627 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18628 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18629
18630internal.htx.free_data : integer
18631 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18632 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18633
18634internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18635 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18636 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18637 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18638
18639internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18640 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18641 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18642
18643internal.htx.size : integer
18644 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18645 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18646
18647internal.htx.used : integer
18648 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18649 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18650 direction.
18651
18652internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18653 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18654 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18655 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18656 of the special value :
18657 * head : The oldest inserted block
18658 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018659 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018660
18661internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18662 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18663 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18664 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18665 integer or one of the special value :
18666 * head : The oldest inserted block
18667 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018668 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018669
18670internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18671 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18672 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18673 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18674 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18675
18676 * head : The oldest inserted block
18677 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018678 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018679
18680internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18681 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18682 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18683 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18684 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18685
18686 * head : The oldest inserted block
18687 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018688 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018689
18690internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18691 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18692 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18693 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18694 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18695
18696 * head : The oldest inserted block
18697 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018698 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018699
18700internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18701 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18702 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18703 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18704 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18705
18706 * head : The oldest inserted block
18707 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018708 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018709
18710internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18711 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18712 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18713 it returns false.
18714
18715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200187167.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018717---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018719Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18720every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018721order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018723ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18724---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018725FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018726HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018727HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18728HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018729HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18730HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18731HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18732HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18733LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018734METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018735METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018736METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18737METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18738METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18739METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018740METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018741METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018742RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018743REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018744TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018745WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18746---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018747
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187498. Logging
18750----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018751
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018752One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18753provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18754very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18755provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18756state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018757to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018758headers.
18759
18760In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18761about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18762send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18763
18764 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18765 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18766 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18767 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18768 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018769 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018770 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018771
18772The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18773allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18774as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18775while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18776real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18777delay.
18778
18779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187808.1. Log levels
18781---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018782
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018783TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018784source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018785HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18786in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18787track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18788syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18789about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018790
18791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187928.2. Log formats
18793----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018794
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018795HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018796and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18797slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18798options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018799
18800 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18801 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18802 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18803 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18804 extents.
18805
18806 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18807 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18808 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18809 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18810 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18811
18812 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18813 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18814 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18815 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18816 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18817
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018818 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18819 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18820 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18821 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18822
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018823 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18824
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018825Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18826specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18827field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18828servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18829always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18830identifier.
18831
18832Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18833 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18834 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18835 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18836 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18837
18838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188398.2.1. Default log format
18840-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018841
18842This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18843as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18844format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18845
18846 Example :
18847 listen www
18848 mode http
18849 log global
18850 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18851
18852 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18853 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18854 (www/HTTP)
18855
18856 Field Format Extract from the example above
18857 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18858 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18859 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18860 4 'to' to
18861 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18862 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18863
18864Detailed fields description :
18865 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18866 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18867 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18868 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18869 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18870 and processed the connection.
18871 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18872
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018873In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18874"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18875connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18876
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018877It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18878will eventually disappear.
18879
18880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188818.2.2. TCP log format
18882---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018883
18884The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18885is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18886information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18887counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18888emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18889environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18890the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18891sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018892specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18893not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18894fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18895marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018896
18897 Example :
18898 frontend fnt
18899 mode tcp
18900 option tcplog
18901 log global
18902 default_backend bck
18903
18904 backend bck
18905 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18906
18907 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18908 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18909 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18910
18911 Field Format Extract from the example above
18912 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18913 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18914 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18915 4 frontend_name fnt
18916 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18917 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18918 7 bytes_read* 212
18919 8 termination_state --
18920 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18921 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18922
18923Detailed fields description :
18924 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018925 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18926 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18927 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018928 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018929 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018930 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018931
18932 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018933 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18934 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18935 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018936
18937 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18938 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18939 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018940 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18941 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18942 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18943 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018944
18945 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18946 and processed the connection.
18947
18948 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18949 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18950 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18951 applications.
18952
18953 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18954 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18955 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18956 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18957 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18958
18959 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18960 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18961 See "Timers" below for more details.
18962
18963 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18964 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18965 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18966 "Timers" below for more details.
18967
18968 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018969 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018970 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18971 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18972 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18973 details.
18974
18975 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18976 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18977 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18978 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18979 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18980
18981 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18982 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18983 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18984 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18985 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18986 for more details.
18987
18988 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018989 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018990 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18991 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18992 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018993 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018994
18995 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18996 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18997 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18998 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18999 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19000 caused by a denial of service attack.
19001
19002 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19003 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19004 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19005 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19006 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19007 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19008 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19009 denial of service attack.
19010
19011 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19012 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19013 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19014 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19015 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19016 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19017 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19018 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19019 be processed than on other servers.
19020
19021 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19022 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19023 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19024 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19025 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19026 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19027 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19028 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19029 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19030 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19031 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19032 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19033 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19034
19035 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19036 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19037 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19038 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19039 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19040 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019041 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019042 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19043
19044 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19045 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19046 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19047 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19048 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19049 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019050 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019051 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19052 occurs.
19053
19054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190558.2.3. HTTP log format
19056----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019057
19058The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19059is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19060the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19061are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19062emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19063generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19064"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19065which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019066frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19067is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019068
19069Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19070slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19071with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19072
19073 Example :
19074 frontend http-in
19075 mode http
19076 option httplog
19077 log global
19078 default_backend bck
19079
19080 backend static
19081 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19082
19083 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19084 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19085 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019086 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019087
19088 Field Format Extract from the example above
19089 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19090 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019091 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019092 4 frontend_name http-in
19093 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019094 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019095 7 status_code 200
19096 8 bytes_read* 2750
19097 9 captured_request_cookie -
19098 10 captured_response_cookie -
19099 11 termination_state ----
19100 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19101 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19102 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19103 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19104 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019105
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019106Detailed fields description :
19107 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019108 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19109 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19110 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019111 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019112 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019113 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019114
19115 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019116 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19117 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19118 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019119
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019120 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19121 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019122
19123 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19124 and processed the connection.
19125
19126 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19127 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19128 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19129
19130 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19131 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19132 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19133 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19134 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19135 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19136
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019137 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19138 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19139 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019140 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019141 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19142 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019143 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19144 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019145
19146 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19147 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019148 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019149
19150 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19151 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019152 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19153 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019154
19155 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19156 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19157 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19158 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19159 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019160 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19161 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019162
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019163 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19164 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19165 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19166 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19167 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19168 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19169 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019170 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019171
19172 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19173 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19174 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19175
19176 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19177 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019178 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019179 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19180 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19181 overflowing.
19182
19183 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19184 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19185 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19186 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19187 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19188 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19189 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19190 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19191
19192 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19193 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19194 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19195 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19196 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19197 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19198 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19199 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19200
19201 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19202 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19203 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19204 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19205 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19206 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19207 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19208
19209 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019210 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019211 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19212 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19213 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019214 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019215 system.
19216
19217 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19218 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19219 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19220 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19221 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19222 caused by a denial of service attack.
19223
19224 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19225 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19226 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19227 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19228 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19229 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19230 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19231 denial of service attack.
19232
19233 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19234 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19235 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19236 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19237 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19238 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19239 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19240 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19241 processed than on other servers.
19242
19243 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19244 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19245 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19246 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19247 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19248 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19249 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19250 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19251 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19252 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19253 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19254 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19255 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19256
19257 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19258 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19259 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19260 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19261 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19262 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019263 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019264 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19265
19266 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19267 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19268 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19269 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19270 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19271 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019272 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019273 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19274 occurs.
19275
19276 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19277 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19278 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19279 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19280 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19281 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19282 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19283 cookies" below for more details.
19284
19285 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19286 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19287 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19288 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19289 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19290 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19291 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19292 and cookies" below for more details.
19293
19294 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19295 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19296 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19297 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19298 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19299 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19300 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19301 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19302
19303
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200193048.2.4. Custom log format
19305------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019306
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019307The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019308mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019309
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019310HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019311Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19312separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19313prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19314
19315Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19316variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019317("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019318
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019319If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019320as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019321less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19322the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19323
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019324Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19325"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19326delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19327preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019328
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019329Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19330'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19331https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19332such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19333
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019334Flags are :
19335 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019336 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019337 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19338 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019339
19340 Example:
19341
19342 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19343 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19344
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019345 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19346
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019347At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19348
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019349 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19350 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019351
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019352the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019353
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019354 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19355 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19356 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019357
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019358and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19359
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019360 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19361 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019362
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019363Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19364
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019365 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019366 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019367 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19368 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19369 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019370 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19371 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19372 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019373 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019374 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
19375 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019376 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019377 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19378 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019379 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019380 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019381 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019382 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019383 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019384 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019385 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019386 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19387 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19388 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19389 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19390 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019391 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019392 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019393 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019394 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019395 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019396 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19397 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019398 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19399 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19400 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019401 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019402 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19403 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019404 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019405 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19406 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19407 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019408 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019409 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019410 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19411 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19412 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19413 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019414 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019415 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019416 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019417 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019418 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019419 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019420 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19421 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19422 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019423 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019424 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19425 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019426 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019427 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19428 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019429 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019430 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019431 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019432 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019433
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019434 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019435
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019436
194378.2.5. Error log format
19438-----------------------
19439
19440When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19441protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19442By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19443"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019444will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019445logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19446
19447The format looks like this :
19448
19449 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19450 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19451 Connection error during SSL handshake
19452
19453 Field Format Extract from the example above
19454 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19455 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19456 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19457 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19458 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19459
19460These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19461failures.
19462
19463
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194648.3. Advanced logging options
19465-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019466
19467Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19468just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19469options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19470for more information about their usage.
19471
19472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194738.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19474------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019475
19476It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19477haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19478commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19479monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19480ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19481
19482 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19483 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19484 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19485 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19486
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019487 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19488 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019489
19490 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19491 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19492 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19493
19494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194958.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19496----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019497
19498The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19499what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19500or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019501"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019502just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19503log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19504after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19505is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19506with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19507with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19508
19509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195108.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19511------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019512
19513Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19514for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19515"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19516retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19517raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19518a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19519file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19520you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19521"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19522
19523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195248.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19525--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019526
19527Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19528multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19529them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19530"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19531logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19532error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19533and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19534too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19535useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19536alternative.
19537
19538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195398.4. Timing events
19540------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019541
19542Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19543reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19544the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19545frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019546mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19547addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19548
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019549Timings events in HTTP mode:
19550
19551 first request 2nd request
19552 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19553 t tr t tr ...
19554 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19555 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19556 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19557 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019558 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019559 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19560
19561Timings events in TCP mode:
19562
19563 TCP session
19564 |<----------------->|
19565 t t
19566 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19567 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19568 |<------ Tt ------->|
19569
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019570 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019571 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019572 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19573 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19574 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019575 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019576 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19577 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19578 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19579 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019580
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019581 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19582 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19583 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019584 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19585 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19586 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19587 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19588 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19589 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019590
19591 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19592 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19593 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19594 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19595 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19596 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19597 request typed by hand during a test.
19598
19599 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19600 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019601 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019602 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19603 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19604 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19605 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019606
19607 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19608 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19609 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19610 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19611 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19612
19613 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19614 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19615 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19616 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19617 connection never established.
19618
19619 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19620 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19621 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19622 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19623 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19624 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19625 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19626 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19627 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19628 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19629 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19630
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019631 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19632 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19633 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19634 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19635 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19636 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19637
19638 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19639
19640 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19641 "Ta" can never be negative.
19642
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019643 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19644 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019645 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19646 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019647 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019648
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019649 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019650
19651 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019652 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19653 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019654
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019655 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19656 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19657 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19658 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19659 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19660 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19661 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19662 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19663
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019664These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19665protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19666that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019667due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19668"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19669that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019670
19671Most common cases :
19672
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019673 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19674 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19675 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19676 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19677 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19678 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19679 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19680 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19681 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19682 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19683 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019684 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019685
19686 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19687 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19688 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19689 of ms on remote networks.
19690
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019691 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19692 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19693 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019694
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019695 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19696 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19697 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19698 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19699 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19700 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19701 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19702 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19703 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019704
19705Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19706
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019707 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019708 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019709 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019710
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019711 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019712 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19713 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19714
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019715 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019716 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19717 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19718 flags.
19719
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019720 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19721 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019722 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19723 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19724 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19725 the client connection was maintained open.
19726
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019727 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019728 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019729 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019730 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19731
19732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197338.5. Session state at disconnection
19734-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019735
19736TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19737"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
197382-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19739each of which has a special meaning :
19740
19741 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19742 session to terminate :
19743
19744 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19745
19746 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19747 server explicitly refused it.
19748
19749 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19750 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19751 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19752 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019753 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019754
19755 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19756 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019757
19758 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19759 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19760 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19761 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19762 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19763
19764 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19765 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19766 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19767 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19768 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19769
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019770 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19771 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19772
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019773 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19774 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19775 backup connections when going up.
19776
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019777 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19778
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019779 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19780 send or receive data.
19781
19782 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19783 send or receive data.
19784
19785 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19786 with nothing left in the buffers.
19787
19788 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19789
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019790 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019791 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19792
19793 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19794 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19795 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19796 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19797 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19798
19799 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19800 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19801
19802 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19803 server (HTTP only).
19804
19805 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19806
19807 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19808 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19809 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19810
19811 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19812 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19813 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19814
19815 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19816
19817 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19818 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19819
19820 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19821 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19822 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19823
19824 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19825 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019826 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19827 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019828
19829 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19830 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19831 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19832 another server.
19833
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019834 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019835 server.
19836
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019837 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19838 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19839 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19840 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19841
19842 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19843 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19844 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19845 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19846
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019847 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19848 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19849 "use-server" rule).
19850
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019851 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19852
19853 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19854 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19855
19856 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19857
19858 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19859 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19860 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19861
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019862 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19863 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019864 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019865 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19866 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19867
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019868 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19869
19870 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19871 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19872
19873 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19874
19875 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19876
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019877The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19878was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019879helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19880starvation, attacks, etc...
19881
19882The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19883alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19884easier finding and understanding.
19885
19886 Flags Reason
19887
19888 -- Normal termination.
19889
19890 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19891 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19892 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19893 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19894
19895 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19896 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19897 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19898 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19899 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19900 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019901
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019902 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19903 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019904 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019905
19906 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19907 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19908 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19909
19910 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19911 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19912 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19913 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19914 the server takes too long to respond.
19915
19916 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19917 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19918 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19919 long a time to respond.
19920
19921 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19922 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19923 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19924 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019925 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19926 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019927
19928 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19929 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19930 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19931 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19932 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019933 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019934 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19935 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19936 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19937 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19938 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19939 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19940 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19941 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019942 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019943 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19944 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19945 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019946
19947 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19948 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019949 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19950 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19951 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19952 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019953
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019954 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19955 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019957 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019958 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19959 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019960 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019961 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19962 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19963
19964 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19965 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19966 503 or 504 here.
19967
19968 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19969 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19970 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19971 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19972 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19973
19974 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19975 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019976 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019977 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19978 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19979
19980 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19981 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19982 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19983 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19984 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19985 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19986 between haproxy and the server.
19987
19988 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19989 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19990 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19991 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19992 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19993 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19994 solution is to fix the application.
19995
19996 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19997 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19998 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19999 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20000 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20001 external attacks.
20002
20003 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
20004 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020005 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020006 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20007 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20008
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020009 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20010 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20011 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020012 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020013 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020014
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020015 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20016 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20017 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20018 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020019 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20020 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20021 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20022 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20023 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020024
20025 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20026 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20027 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20028 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20029
20030 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20031 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20032 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20033 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20034
20035 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20036 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20037 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20038 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20039
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020040The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20041persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20042important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20043re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20044
20045 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20046
20047 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20048 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20049 set on a GET request.
20050
20051 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20052 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020053 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020054 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20055
20056 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20057 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20058 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20059
20060 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20061 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20062 already got a cookie.
20063
20064 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20065 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20066 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20067 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20068 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20069
20070 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20071 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20072 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20073
20074 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20075 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20076 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20077
20078 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20079 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20080
20081 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20082 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20083 then advertised in the response.
20084
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200868.6. Non-printable characters
20087-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020088
20089In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20090consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20091converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20092prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20093being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20094escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20095is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20096'}' when logging headers.
20097
20098Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20099issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20100containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20101
20102Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20103the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20104performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20105
20106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201078.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20108---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020109
20110Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20111achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020112section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020113cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20114the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20115the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020116locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020117not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20118user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20119a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20120wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20121
20122 Examples :
20123 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20124 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20125
20126 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20127 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20128
20129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201308.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20131---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020132
20133Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20134proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20135the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20136server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20137
20138Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20139response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020140section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020141
20142It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020143time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20144appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020145are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20146and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20147follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20148request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20149in the logs.
20150
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020151As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20152frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20153an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20154
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020155 Example :
20156 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20157 listen proxy-out
20158 mode http
20159 option httplog
20160 option logasap
20161 log global
20162 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20163
20164 # log the name of the virtual server
20165 capture request header Host len 20
20166
20167 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20168 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20169
20170 # log the beginning of the referrer
20171 capture request header Referer len 20
20172
20173 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20174 capture response header Server len 20
20175
20176 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20177 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20178
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020179 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020180 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20181
20182 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20183 capture response header Via len 20
20184
20185 # log the URL location during a redirection
20186 capture response header Location len 20
20187
20188 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20189 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20190 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20191 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20192 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20193
20194 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20195 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20196 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20197 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020198 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020199
20200 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20201 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20202 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20203 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20204 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020205 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020206
20207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202088.9. Examples of logs
20209---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020210
20211These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20212them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20213reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20214
20215 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20216 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20217 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20218
20219 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20220 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20221
20222 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20223 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20224 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20225
20226 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20227 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20228
20229 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20230 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20231 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20232
20233 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020234 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020235 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20236 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20237
20238 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20239 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20240 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20241
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020242 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20243 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20244 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20245 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20246 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20247 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020248
20249 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020250 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020251
20252 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20253 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20254 Nothing was sent to any server.
20255
20256 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20257 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20258
20259 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20260 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020261 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020262 send a 408 return code to the client.
20263
20264 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20265 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20266
20267 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20268 5 seconds ("c----").
20269
20270 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20271 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020272 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020273
20274 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020275 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020276 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20277 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20278 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20279 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20280 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020281
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020282
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200202839. Supported filters
20284--------------------
20285
20286Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20287accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20288unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20289
20290See also : "filter"
20291
202929.1. Trace
20293----------
20294
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020295filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020296
20297 Arguments:
20298 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20299 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20300
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020301 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020302
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020303 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020304 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20305 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20306 amount of the parsed data.
20307
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020308 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020309
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020310This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20311callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20312information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20313filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20314
20315Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20316tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20317a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20318
20319
203209.2. HTTP compression
20321---------------------
20322
20323filter compression
20324
20325The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20326keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020327when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20328fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20329done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20330explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20331filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20332listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20333order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020334
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020335See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20336 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020337
20338
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200203399.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20340--------------------------------------------
20341
20342filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20343
20344 Arguments :
20345
20346 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20347 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20348 parsed.
20349
20350 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20351 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20352 part must be placed in its own scope.
20353
20354The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20355external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020356streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020357exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20358also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20359
20360SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20361the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20362
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020363For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020364"doc/SPOE.txt".
20365
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100203669.4. Cache
20367----------
20368
20369filter cache <name>
20370
20371 Arguments :
20372
20373 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20374
20375The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20376"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020377cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020378other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20379case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20380is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20381filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020382listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20383order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020384
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020385See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20386 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20387
20388
203899.5. Fcgi-app
20390-------------
20391
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020392filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020393
20394 Arguments :
20395
20396 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20397
20398The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20399request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20400reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20401used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20402implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20403used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20404fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20405used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20406order.
20407
20408See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20409 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20410
20411
2041210. FastCGI applications
20413-------------------------
20414
20415HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20416feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20417the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20418FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20419servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20420FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20421backend.
20422
20423HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20424application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20425connection.
20426
2042710.1. Setup
20428-----------
20429
2043010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20431--------------------------
20432
20433fcgi-app <name>
20434 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20435 document root must be defined.
20436
20437acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20438 Declare or complete an access list.
20439
20440 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20441 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20442 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20443 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20444 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20445
20446docroot <path>
20447 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20448 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20449 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20450
20451index <script-name>
20452 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20453 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20454 is an optional setting.
20455
20456 Example :
20457 index index.php
20458
20459log-stderr global
20460log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20461 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20462 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20463
20464 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20465 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20466
20467pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20468 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20469 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20470 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20471
20472 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20473 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20474 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20475 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20476
20477 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20478 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20479
20480path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020481 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020482 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20483 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20484 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20485 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20486 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20487 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20488 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020489
20490 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020491 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020492 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20493 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20494 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20495 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020496
20497 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020498 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20499 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020500
20501option get-values
20502no option get-values
20503 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20504
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020505 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020506 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20507
20508 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20509 application will accept.
20510
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020511 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20512 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020513
20514 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020515 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020516 option is disabled.
20517
20518 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20519 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20520 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20521 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20522 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20523 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20524
20525option keep-conn
20526no option keep-conn
20527 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20528 sending a response.
20529
20530 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20531 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20532
20533option max-reqs <reqs>
20534 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20535 accept.
20536
20537 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20538 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20539 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20540 to 1.
20541
20542option mpxs-conns
20543no option mpxs-conns
20544 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20545
20546 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20547 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20548
20549set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20550 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20551 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20552 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20553 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20554
20555 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20556 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20557 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20558
20559 Example :
20560 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20561 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20562
20563 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20564
20565
2056610.1.2. Proxy section
20567---------------------
20568
20569use-fcgi-app <name>
20570 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20571
20572 Arguments :
20573 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20574
20575 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20576 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20577 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20578 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20579 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20580
20581 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20582 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20583 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20584 application are evaluated.
20585
20586
2058710.1.3. Example
20588---------------
20589
20590 frontend front-http
20591 mode http
20592 bind *:80
20593 bind *:
20594
20595 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20596 default_backend back-static
20597
20598 backend back-static
20599 mode http
20600 server www A.B.C.D:80
20601
20602 backend back-dynamic
20603 mode http
20604 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20605 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20606
20607 fcgi-app php-fpm
20608 log-stderr global
20609 option keep-conn
20610
20611 docroot /var/www/my-app
20612 index index.php
20613 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20614
20615
2061610.2. Default parameters
20617------------------------
20618
20619A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20620the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020621script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020622applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20623
20624 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20625 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20626 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20627 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20628 | | |
20629 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20630 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20631 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20632 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20633 | | application. |
20634 | | |
20635 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20636 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20637 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20638 | | |
20639 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20640 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20641 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20642 | | the application's configuration. |
20643 | | |
20644 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20645 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20646 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20647 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20648 | | |
20649 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20650 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20651 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20652 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20653 | | be defined. |
20654 | | |
20655 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20656 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20657 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20658 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20659 | | is not set too. |
20660 | | |
20661 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20662 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20663 | | set. |
20664 | | |
20665 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20666 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20667 | | the request. |
20668 | | |
20669 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20670 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20671 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20672 | | |
20673 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20674 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20675 | | script to process the request. |
20676 | | |
20677 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20678 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20679 | | |
20680 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20681 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20682 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20683 | | |
20684 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20685 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20686 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20687 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20688 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20689 | | |
20690 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20691 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20692 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20693 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20694 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20695 | | side. |
20696 | | |
20697 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20698 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20699 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20700 | | connected to. |
20701 | | |
20702 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20703 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20704 | | |
20705 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20706 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20707 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20708 | | |
20709 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20710
20711
2071210.3. Limitations
20713------------------
20714
20715The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20716way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20717during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20718establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20719application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20720or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20721message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20722these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20723and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20724
20725Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20726request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20727requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20728
20729About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20730into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20731fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20732"http-request" ones.
20733
20734Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20735FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20736processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20737must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20738here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020739
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020740/*
20741 * Local variables:
20742 * fill-column: 79
20743 * End:
20744 */